ELF DWARF in PE output
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
... / ...
CommitLineData
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@syncodeindex ky cp
5@c man begin INCLUDE
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8@include bfdver.texi
9@c man end
10
11@c @smallbook
12
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
22@set ARM
23@set C6X
24@set CSKY
25@set H8300
26@set HPPA
27@set M68HC11
28@set M68K
29@set MIPS
30@set MMIX
31@set MSP430
32@set NDS32
33@set NIOSII
34@set PDP11
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
37@set Renesas
38@set S/390
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
41@set WIN32
42@set XTENSA
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
52
53@copying
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
59
60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68@end copying
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
72@settitle The GNU linker
73@titlepage
74@title The GNU linker
75@sp 1
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105@c man end
106
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
109@contents
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112@ifnottex
113@node Top
114@top LD
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
120
121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139@end ifset
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185* LD Index:: LD Index
186@end menu
187@end ifnottex
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
194
195@ifset man
196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222@end ifset
223
224@ifclear SingleFormat
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238@c man end
239
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249@c man end
250
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
253* Options:: Command-line Options
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
258@section Command-line Options
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
336
337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
341
342@smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
357
358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359linker:
360
361@table @gcctabopt
362@include at-file.texi
363
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381interface.
382
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407particular format.
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
444@item -d
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
509@item -e @var{entry}
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
568
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
591@ifclear SingleFormat
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
602@end ifclear
603
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
621machine-specific performance.
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
628@item -F @var{name}
629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
654
655@cindex finalization function
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
669@cindex object size
670@item -G @var{value}
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
678@kindex -h @var{name}
679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
680@item -h @var{name}
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
693@cindex initialization function
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
704@item -l @var{namespec}
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
711
712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
740@kindex -L @var{dir}
741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
742@item -L @var{searchdir}
743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
753
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
757
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
770@item -m @var{emulation}
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
790Where object files are mapped into memory.
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
824
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
827
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
842@end smallexample
843
844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
847@end itemize
848
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
871@item -N
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
922
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
937just copy in the newest one.
938
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
964@item --pop-state
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
989@kindex --relocatable
990@item -r
991@itemx --relocatable
992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
997@c ; see @option{-N}.
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1022the @option{-rpath} option.
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
1027@item -s
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
1034@item -S
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
1048@item -t
1049@itemx --trace
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
1068
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
1114@item -Ur
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
1162
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
1183@item -X
1184@itemx --discard-locals
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
1241@item combreloc
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1245
1246@item common
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
1255
1256@item defs
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1260
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1286
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
1291@item ibt
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
1296@item initfirst
1297This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1298It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1299before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1300the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1301the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1302objects.
1303
1304@item interpose
1305Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1306so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1307libraries not so marked.
1308
1309@item unique
1310@itemx nounique
1311When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1312object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1313and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1314primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1315al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1316of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1317and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1318
1319@item lam-u48
1320Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1321to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1322
1323@item lam-u57
1324Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1325to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1326
1327@item lam-u48-report=none
1328@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1329@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1330Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1331property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1332@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1333linker not report missing properties in input files.
1334@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1335missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1336make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1337Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u57-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-report=none
1352@itemx lam-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1355GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1356section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1360the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363@item lazy
1364When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1365dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1366the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1367Lazy binding is the default.
1368
1369@item loadfltr
1370Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1371
1372@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1373Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1374
1375@item muldefs
1376Allow multiple definitions.
1377
1378@item nocopyreloc
1379Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1380defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1381
1382@item nodefaultlib
1383Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1384should ignore any default library search paths.
1385
1386@item nodelete
1387Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1388
1389@item nodlopen
1390Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1391
1392@item nodump
1393Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1394
1395@item noexecstack
1396Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1397
1398@item noextern-protected-data
1399Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1400library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1401used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1402generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1403module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1404i386 and x86-64.
1405
1406@item noreloc-overflow
1407Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1408relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1409overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1410
1411@item now
1412When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1413dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1414when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1415function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1416called.
1417
1418@item origin
1419Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1420
1421@item relro
1422@itemx norelro
1423Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1424specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1425relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1426than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1427Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1428
1429@item report-relative-reloc
1430Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1431Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1432
1433@item separate-code
1434@itemx noseparate-code
1435Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1436specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1437be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1438code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1439
1440@item unique-symbol
1441@itemx nounique-symbol
1442Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1443".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1444is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1445
1446@item shstk
1447Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1448to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1449Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1450
1451@item stack-size=@var{value}
1452Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1453Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1454@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1455
1456@item start-stop-gc
1457@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1458@cindex start-stop-gc
1459When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1460section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1461input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1462@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1463@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1464linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1465sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1466were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1467definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1468object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1469linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1470@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1471treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1472
1473@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1474@cindex visibility
1475@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1476Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1477@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1478Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1479@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1480start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1481compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1482recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1483programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1484between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1485
1486@item text
1487@itemx notext
1488@itemx textoff
1489Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1490or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1491report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1492
1493@item undefs
1494Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1495either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1496This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1497
1498@item x86-64-baseline
1499@item x86-64-v2
1500@item x86-64-v3
1501@itemx x86-64-v4
1502Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1503@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1504@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1505@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1506@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1507Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1508
1509@end table
1510
1511Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1512
1513@kindex -(
1514@cindex groups of archives
1515@item -( @var{archives} -)
1516@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1517The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1518either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1519
1520The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1521references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1522the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1523archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1524object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1525would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1526they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1527resolved.
1528
1529Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1530it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1531more archives.
1532
1533@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1534@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1535@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1536@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1537Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1538recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1539and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1540the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1541behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1542so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1543restore the old behaviour.
1544
1545@kindex --as-needed
1546@kindex --no-as-needed
1547@item --as-needed
1548@itemx --no-as-needed
1549This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1550on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1551the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1552on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1553needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1554emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1555non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1556the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1557non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1558Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1559the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1560needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1561from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1562
1563@kindex --add-needed
1564@kindex --no-add-needed
1565@item --add-needed
1566@itemx --no-add-needed
1567These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1568their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1569options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1570and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1571
1572@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1573@item -assert @var{keyword}
1574This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1575
1576@kindex -Bdynamic
1577@kindex -dy
1578@kindex -call_shared
1579@item -Bdynamic
1580@itemx -dy
1581@itemx -call_shared
1582Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1583for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1584default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1585for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1586multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1587@option{-l} options which follow it.
1588
1589@kindex -Bgroup
1590@item -Bgroup
1591Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1592section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1593object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1594@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1595only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1596
1597@kindex -Bstatic
1598@kindex -dn
1599@kindex -non_shared
1600@kindex -static
1601@item -Bstatic
1602@itemx -dn
1603@itemx -non_shared
1604@itemx -static
1605Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1606platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1607variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1608may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1609library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1610option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1611option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1612shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1613references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1614libraries.
1615
1616@kindex -Bsymbolic
1617@item -Bsymbolic
1618When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1619definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1620for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1621within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1622platforms which support shared libraries.
1623
1624@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1625@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1626When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1627symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1628This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1629libraries.
1630
1631@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1632@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1633Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1634typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1635global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1636within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1637to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1638in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1639which support shared libraries.
1640
1641The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1642scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1643
1644@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1645@item --dynamic-list-data
1646Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1647
1648@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1649@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1650Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1651is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1652
1653@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1654@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1655Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1656
1657@kindex --check-sections
1658@kindex --no-check-sections
1659@item --check-sections
1660@itemx --no-check-sections
1661Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1662been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1663perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1664suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1665allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1666restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1667Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1668force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1669option.
1670
1671@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1672@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1673@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1674@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1675This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1676by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1677command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1678output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1679input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1680specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1681follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1682behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1683
1684This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1685libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1686mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1687their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1688required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1689the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1690dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1691symbols.
1692
1693@cindex cross reference table
1694@kindex --cref
1695@item --cref
1696Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1697generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1698Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1699
1700The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1701easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1702sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1703symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1704definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1705where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1706symbol are listed.
1707
1708@cindex ctf variables
1709@kindex --ctf-variables
1710@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1711@item --ctf-variables
1712@item --no-ctf-variables
1713The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1714types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1715table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1716conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1717usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1718@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1719The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1720
1721@cindex ctf type sharing
1722@kindex --ctf-share-types
1723@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1724Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1725
1726@table @samp
1727@item share-unconflicted
1728Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1729where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1730translation unit. This is the default.
1731
1732@item share-duplicated
1733Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1734dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1735dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1736always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1737larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1738large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1739consumer at runtime.
1740@end table
1741
1742@cindex common allocation
1743@kindex --no-define-common
1744@item --no-define-common
1745This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1746The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1747@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1748
1749The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1750the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1751of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1752forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1753Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1754from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1755This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1756and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1757duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1758paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1759
1760@cindex group allocation in linker script
1761@cindex section groups
1762@cindex COMDAT
1763@kindex --force-group-allocation
1764@item --force-group-allocation
1765This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1766normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1767default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1768change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1769command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1770effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1771
1772@cindex symbols, from command line
1773@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1774@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1775Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1776address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1777times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1778limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1779context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1780symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1781constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1782using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1783@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1784equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1785
1786The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1787in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1788symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1789placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1790the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1791consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1792@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1793you are trying to achieve.
1794
1795@cindex demangling, from command line
1796@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1797@kindex --no-demangle
1798@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1799@itemx --no-demangle
1800These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1801and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1802present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1803underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1804mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1805different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1806to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1807demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1808is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1809
1810@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1811@kindex -I@var{file}
1812@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1813@item -I@var{file}
1814@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1815Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1816generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1817linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1818doing.
1819
1820@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1821@item --no-dynamic-linker
1822When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1823linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1824executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1825entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1826
1827@kindex --embedded-relocs
1828@item --embedded-relocs
1829This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1830that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1831is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1832targets.
1833
1834@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1835@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1836Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1837in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1838
1839@kindex --fatal-warnings
1840@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1841@item --fatal-warnings
1842@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1843Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1844with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1845
1846@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1847@item --force-exe-suffix
1848Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1849
1850If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1851@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1852the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1853option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1854Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1855it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1856
1857@kindex --gc-sections
1858@kindex --no-gc-sections
1859@cindex garbage collection
1860@item --gc-sections
1861@itemx --no-gc-sections
1862Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1863targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1864performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1865@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1866collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1867implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1868
1869@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1870examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1871symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1872command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1873referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1874libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1875referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1876the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1877relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1878@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1879
1880This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1881@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1882specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1883@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1884command in the linker script.
1885
1886As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1887@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1888
1889@kindex --print-gc-sections
1890@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1891@cindex garbage collection
1892@item --print-gc-sections
1893@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1894List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1895printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1896collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1897default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1898be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1899line.
1900
1901@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1902@cindex garbage collection
1903@item --gc-keep-exported
1904When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1905collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1906default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1907executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1908collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1909Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1910it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1911ELF format targets.
1912
1913@kindex --print-output-format
1914@cindex output format
1915@item --print-output-format
1916Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1917other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1918in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1919
1920@kindex --print-memory-usage
1921@cindex memory usage
1922@item --print-memory-usage
1923Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1924the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1925quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1926headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1927parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1928
1929@smallexample
1930Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1931 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1932 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1933@end smallexample
1934
1935@cindex help
1936@cindex usage
1937@kindex --help
1938@item --help
1939Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1940
1941@kindex --target-help
1942@item --target-help
1943Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1944
1945@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1946@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1947Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1948@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1949@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1950
1951Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1952written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1953inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1954file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1955@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1956output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1957@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1958
1959@smallexample
1960 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1961 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1962 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1963 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1964 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1965 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1966 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1967 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1968 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1969 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1970@end smallexample
1971
1972It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1973
1974If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1975operation.
1976
1977@cindex memory usage
1978@kindex --no-keep-memory
1979@item --no-keep-memory
1980@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1981symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
1982instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
1983necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
1984while linking a large executable.
1985
1986@kindex --no-undefined
1987@kindex -z defs
1988@kindex -z undefs
1989@item --no-undefined
1990@itemx -z defs
1991Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1992is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1993The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1994behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
1995libraries being linked in.
1996
1997The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1998
1999@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2000@kindex -z muldefs
2001@item --allow-multiple-definition
2002@itemx -z muldefs
2003Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2004report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2005first definition will be used.
2006
2007@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2008@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2009@item --allow-shlib-undefined
2010@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2011Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2012This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2013determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2014shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2015how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2016
2017The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2018referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2019an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2020a shared library.
2021
2022The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2023libraries specified at link time are that:
2024
2025@itemize @bullet
2026@item
2027A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2028that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2029resolvable at load time.
2030@item
2031There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2032symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2033
2034The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2035select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2036architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2037appropriate memset function.
2038@end itemize
2039
2040@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2041@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2042If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2043@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2044only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2045libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2046``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2047undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2048will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2049might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2050error message will be displayed.
2051
2052The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2053switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2054
2055@kindex --no-undefined-version
2056@item --no-undefined-version
2057Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2058it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2059will be issued instead.
2060
2061@kindex --default-symver
2062@item --default-symver
2063Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2064exported symbols.
2065
2066@kindex --default-imported-symver
2067@item --default-imported-symver
2068Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2069imported symbols.
2070
2071@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2072@item --no-warn-mismatch
2073Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2074files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2075been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2076This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2077errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2078have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2079inappropriate.
2080
2081@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2082@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2083Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2084library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2085
2086@kindex --no-whole-archive
2087@item --no-whole-archive
2088Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2089archive files.
2090
2091@cindex output file after errors
2092@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2093@item --noinhibit-exec
2094Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2095Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2096errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2097when it issues any error whatsoever.
2098
2099@kindex -nostdlib
2100@item -nostdlib
2101Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2102command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2103(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2104
2105@ifclear SingleFormat
2106@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2107@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2108@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2109file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2110@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2111object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2112object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2113should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2114usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2115name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2116list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2117command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2118this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2119@end ifclear
2120
2121@kindex --out-implib
2122@item --out-implib @var{file}
2123Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2124the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2125library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2126may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2127behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2128step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2129the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2130
2131@kindex -pie
2132@kindex --pic-executable
2133@item -pie
2134@itemx --pic-executable
2135@cindex position independent executables
2136Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2137ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2138libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2139address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2140normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2141defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2142
2143@kindex -qmagic
2144@item -qmagic
2145This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2146
2147@kindex -Qy
2148@item -Qy
2149This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2150
2151@kindex --relax
2152@cindex synthesizing linker
2153@cindex relaxing addressing modes
2154@cindex --no-relax
2155@item --relax
2156@itemx --no-relax
2157An option with machine dependent effects.
2158@ifset GENERIC
2159This option is only supported on a few targets.
2160@end ifset
2161@ifset H8300
2162@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2163@end ifset
2164@ifset XTENSA
2165@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2166@end ifset
2167@ifset M68HC11
2168@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2169@end ifset
2170@ifset NIOSII
2171@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2172@end ifset
2173@ifset POWERPC
2174@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2175@end ifset
2176
2177On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2178global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2179addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2180synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2181instructions, and combining constant values.
2182
2183On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2184debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2185@ifset GENERIC
2186This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2187family of processors.
2188@end ifset
2189
2190On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2191@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2192
2193On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2194and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2195
2196@cindex retaining specified symbols
2197@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2198@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2199@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2200@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2201Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2202discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2203symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2204@ifset GENERIC
2205(such as VxWorks)
2206@end ifset
2207where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2208run-time memory.
2209
2210@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2211or symbols needed for relocations.
2212
2213You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2214line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2215
2216@ifset GENERIC
2217@item -rpath=@var{dir}
2218@cindex runtime library search path
2219@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2220Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2221linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2222arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2223them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2224
2225The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2226are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2227description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2228in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2229have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2230
2231If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2232contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2233is defined.
2234
2235The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2236SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2237@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2238runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2239options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2240gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2241file systems.
2242
2243For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2244followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2245the @option{-rpath} option.
2246@end ifset
2247
2248@ifset GENERIC
2249@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2250@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2251@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2252When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2253happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2254of the input files.
2255
2256When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2257non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2258shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2259explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2260specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2261@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2262either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2263appearing multiple times.
2264
2265The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2266directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2267containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2268and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
226964-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2270
2271The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2272@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2273supported.
2274
2275This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2276that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2277is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2278runtime linker would do.
2279
2280The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2281libraries:
2282
2283@enumerate
2284@item
2285Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2286@item
2287Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2288between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2289specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2290used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2291at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2292by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2293the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2294@item
2295On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2296@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2297environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2298@item
2299On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2300directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2301@item
2302For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2303variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2304@item
2305For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2306@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2307libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2308@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2309@item
2310The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2311@item
2312For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2313exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2314to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2315defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2316configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2317@item
2318For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2319the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2320header file.
2321@item
2322Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2323linker script being used.
2324@end enumerate
2325
2326If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2327warning and continue with the link.
2328@end ifset
2329
2330@kindex -shared
2331@kindex -Bshareable
2332@item -shared
2333@itemx -Bshareable
2334@cindex shared libraries
2335Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2336and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2337shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2338undefined symbols in the link.
2339
2340@kindex --sort-common
2341@item --sort-common
2342@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2343@itemx --sort-common=descending
2344This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2345ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2346sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2347eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2348between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2349specified, then descending order is assumed.
2350
2351@kindex --sort-section=name
2352@item --sort-section=name
2353This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2354patterns in the linker script.
2355
2356@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2357@item --sort-section=alignment
2358This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2359patterns in the linker script.
2360
2361@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2362@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2363This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2364.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2365post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2366
2367@kindex --split-by-file
2368@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2369Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2370each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2371size of 1 if not given.
2372
2373@kindex --split-by-reloc
2374@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2375Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2376output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2377This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2378certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2379cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2380that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2381support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2382input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2383more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2384many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2385
2386@kindex --stats
2387@item --stats
2388Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2389as execution time and memory usage.
2390
2391@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2392@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2393Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2394configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2395that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2396
2397@kindex --task-link
2398@item --task-link
2399This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2400file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2401
2402@kindex --traditional-format
2403@cindex traditional format
2404@item --traditional-format
2405For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2406the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2407use the traditional format instead.
2408
2409@cindex dbx
2410For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2411symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2412full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2413@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2414trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2415combine duplicate entries.
2416
2417@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2418@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2419Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2420address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2421times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2422line.
2423@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2424for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2425@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2426should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2427sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2428
2429@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2430@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2431@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2432@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2433@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2434@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2435@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2436Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2437@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2438
2439@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2440@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2441@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2442When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2443byte of the text segment.
2444
2445@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2446@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2447@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2448When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2449the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2450text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2451
2452@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2453@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2454@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2455When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2456model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2457
2458@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2459@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2460Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2461values for @samp{method}:
2462
2463@table @samp
2464@item ignore-all
2465Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2466
2467@item report-all
2468Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2469
2470@item ignore-in-object-files
2471Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2472ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2473
2474@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2475Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2476ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2477when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2478libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2479command line.
2480@end table
2481
2482The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2483by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2484
2485Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2486unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2487can change this to a warning.
2488
2489@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2490@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2491@item --dll-verbose
2492@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2493Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2494supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2495the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2496argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2497
2498@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2499@cindex version script, symbol versions
2500@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2501Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2502used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2503about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2504is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2505see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2506use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2507symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2508@xref{WIN32}.
2509
2510@kindex --warn-common
2511@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2512@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2513@item --warn-common
2514Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2515a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2516but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2517you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2518Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2519warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2520
2521There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2522
2523@table @samp
2524@item int i = 1;
2525A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2526file.
2527
2528@item extern int i;
2529An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2530There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2531variable somewhere.
2532
2533@item int i;
2534A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2535variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2536The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2537single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2538size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2539a definition of the same variable.
2540@end table
2541
2542The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2543Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2544just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2545encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2546a common symbol.
2547
2548@enumerate
2549@item
2550Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2551definition for the symbol.
2552@smallexample
2553@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2554 overridden by definition
2555@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2556@end smallexample
2557
2558@item
2559Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2560the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2561except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2562@smallexample
2563@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2564 overriding common
2565@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2566@end smallexample
2567
2568@item
2569Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2570@smallexample
2571@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2572 of `@var{symbol}'
2573@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2574@end smallexample
2575
2576@item
2577Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2578@smallexample
2579@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2580 overridden by larger common
2581@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2582@end smallexample
2583
2584@item
2585Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2586the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2587encountered in a different order.
2588@smallexample
2589@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2590 overriding smaller common
2591@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2592@end smallexample
2593@end enumerate
2594
2595@kindex --warn-constructors
2596@item --warn-constructors
2597Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2598object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2599detect the use of global constructors.
2600
2601@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2602@item --warn-multiple-gp
2603Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2604This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2605Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2606section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2607of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2608base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2609base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2610bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2611large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2612values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2613option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2614
2615@kindex --warn-once
2616@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2617@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2618@item --warn-once
2619Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2620which refers to it.
2621
2622@kindex --warn-section-align
2623@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2624@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2625@item --warn-section-align
2626Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2627alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2628The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2629is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2630the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2631
2632@kindex --warn-textrel
2633@item --warn-textrel
2634Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2635or shared object.
2636
2637@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2638@item --warn-alternate-em
2639Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2640
2641@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2642@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2643If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2644@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2645This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2646
2647@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2648@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2649This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2650it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2651
2652@kindex --whole-archive
2653@cindex including an entire archive
2654@item --whole-archive
2655For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2656@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2657in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2658files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2659library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2660library. This option may be used more than once.
2661
2662Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2663about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2664Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2665list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2666your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2667
2668@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2669@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2670Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2671@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2672undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2673@var{symbol}.
2674
2675This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2676wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2677wishes to call the system function, it should call
2678@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2679
2680Here is a trivial example:
2681
2682@smallexample
2683void *
2684__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2685@{
2686 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2687 return __real_malloc (c);
2688@}
2689@end smallexample
2690
2691If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2692all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2693instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2694call the real @code{malloc} function.
2695
2696You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2697links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2698you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2699file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2700call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2701
2702Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2703internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2704@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2705@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2706
2707@smallexample
2708int
2709f (void)
2710@{
2711 return 123;
2712@}
2713
2714int
2715g (void)
2716@{
2717 return f();
2718@}
2719@end smallexample
2720
2721@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2722@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2723@item --eh-frame-hdr
2724@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2725Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2726(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2727section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2728
2729@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2730@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2731Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2732generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2733if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2734
2735@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2736@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2737@item --enable-new-dtags
2738@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2739This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2740systems may not understand them. If you specify
2741@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2742and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2743If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2744created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2745those options are only available for ELF systems.
2746
2747@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2748@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2749Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2750close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2751time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2752increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2753value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2754
2755@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2756@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2757Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2758@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2759new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2760the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2761hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2762but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2763
2764@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2765@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2766@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2767@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2768@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2769@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2770@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2771@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2772On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2773compressed using zlib.
2774
2775@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2776sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2777DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2778instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2779also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2780sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2781
2782The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2783@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2784
2785Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2786sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2787for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2788uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2789
2790The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2791involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2792default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2793@option{--help} option.
2794
2795@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2796@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2797This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2798linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2799for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2800about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2801
2802Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
28031021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2804run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2805has been used.
2806
2807The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2808enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2809
2810@kindex --build-id
2811@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2812@item --build-id
2813@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2814Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2815or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2816unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2817@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2818@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2819@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2820the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2821string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2822@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2823is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2824
2825The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2826that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2827unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2828to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2829file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2830string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2831
2832Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2833@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2834@end table
2835
2836@c man end
2837
2838@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2839
2840@c man begin OPTIONS
2841
2842The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2843the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2844normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2845use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2846@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2847like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2848symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2849object file).
2850
2851In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2852support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2853PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2854values by either a space or an equals sign.
2855
2856@table @gcctabopt
2857
2858@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2859@item --add-stdcall-alias
2860If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2861as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2862[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2863
2864@kindex --base-file
2865@item --base-file @var{file}
2866Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2867addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2868@file{dlltool}.
2869[This is an i386 PE specific option]
2870
2871@kindex --dll
2872@item --dll
2873Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
2874@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2875file.
2876[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2877
2878@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2879@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2880@item --enable-long-section-names
2881@itemx --disable-long-section-names
2882The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
2883the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
2884for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2885fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
2886to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2887allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2888disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2889generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2890as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
2891with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2892GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
2893information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2894option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2895section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2896when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2897image and not stripping symbols.
2898[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2899
2900@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2901@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2902@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2903@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2904If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
2905do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
2906only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2907resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2908undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2909@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2910to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2911warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2912import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
2913to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
2914feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
2915@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
2916mismatches are considered to be errors.
2917[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2918
2919@kindex --leading-underscore
2920@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2921@item --leading-underscore
2922@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2923For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2924in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2925disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2926
2927@cindex DLLs, creating
2928@kindex --export-all-symbols
2929@item --export-all-symbols
2930If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2931be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2932otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2933explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2934attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2935option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
2936@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
2937@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
2938exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2939re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2940such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2941@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
2942@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2943Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2944not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
2945extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
2946(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
2947These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2948@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2949@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
2950@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
2951@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
2952[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2953
2954@kindex --exclude-symbols
2955@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
2956Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2957exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
2958[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2959
2960@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2961@item --exclude-all-symbols
2962Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2963[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2964
2965@kindex --file-alignment
2966@item --file-alignment
2967Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2968file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2969512.
2970[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2971
2972@cindex heap size
2973@kindex --heap
2974@item --heap @var{reserve}
2975@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
2976Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
2977to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
2978committed.
2979[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2980
2981@cindex image base
2982@kindex --image-base
2983@item --image-base @var{value}
2984Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2985the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2986is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2987your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2988other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2989for dlls.
2990[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2991
2992@kindex --kill-at
2993@item --kill-at
2994If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2995symbols before they are exported.
2996[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2997
2998@kindex --large-address-aware
2999@item --large-address-aware
3000If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3001header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3002greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3003or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3004section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3005[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3006
3007@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3008@item --disable-large-address-aware
3009Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3010This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3011driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3012addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3013[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3014
3015@kindex --major-image-version
3016@item --major-image-version @var{value}
3017Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3018[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3019
3020@kindex --major-os-version
3021@item --major-os-version @var{value}
3022Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3023[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3024
3025@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3026@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3027Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3028[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3029
3030@kindex --minor-image-version
3031@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3032Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3033[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3034
3035@kindex --minor-os-version
3036@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3037Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3038[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3039
3040@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3041@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3042Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3043[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3044
3045@cindex DEF files, creating
3046@cindex DLLs, creating
3047@kindex --output-def
3048@item --output-def @var{file}
3049The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3050file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3051(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3052library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3053automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3054[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3055
3056@cindex DLLs, creating
3057@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3058@item --enable-auto-image-base
3059@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3060Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3061@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3062By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3063for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3064execution are avoided.
3065[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3066
3067@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3068@item --disable-auto-image-base
3069Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3070user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3071default.
3072[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3073
3074@cindex DLLs, linking to
3075@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3076@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3077When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3078search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3079@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3080between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3081uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3082@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3083[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3084
3085@kindex --enable-auto-import
3086@item --enable-auto-import
3087Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3088DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3089mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3090[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3091
3092The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3093feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3094
3095Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3096of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3097PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3098
3099Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3100data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3101placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3102around a problem with consts that is described here:
3103http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3104
3105Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3106see this message:
3107
3108"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3109documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3110
3111This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3112ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3113allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3114fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3115constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3116multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3117this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3118of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3119the warning, and exit.
3120
3121There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3122data type of the exported variable:
3123
3124One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3125of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3126this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3127
3128A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3129that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3130there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3131a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3132
3133@example
3134extern type extern_array[];
3135extern_array[1] -->
3136 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3137@end example
3138
3139or
3140
3141@example
3142extern type extern_array[];
3143extern_array[1] -->
3144 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3145@end example
3146
3147For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3148is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3149
3150@example
3151extern struct s extern_struct;
3152extern_struct.field -->
3153 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3154@end example
3155
3156or
3157
3158@example
3159extern long long extern_ll;
3160extern_ll -->
3161 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3162@end example
3163
3164A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3165'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3166@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3167requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3168building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3169merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3170between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3171constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3172
3173Original:
3174@example
3175--foo.h
3176extern int arr[];
3177--foo.c
3178#include "foo.h"
3179void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3180 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3181@}
3182@end example
3183
3184Solution 1:
3185@example
3186--foo.h
3187extern int arr[];
3188--foo.c
3189#include "foo.h"
3190void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3191 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3192 volatile int *parr = arr;
3193 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3194@}
3195@end example
3196
3197Solution 2:
3198@example
3199--foo.h
3200/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3201#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3202 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3203#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3204#else
3205#define FOO_IMPORT
3206#endif
3207extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3208--foo.c
3209#include "foo.h"
3210void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3211 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3212@}
3213@end example
3214
3215A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3216library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3217for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3218functions).
3219
3220@kindex --disable-auto-import
3221@item --disable-auto-import
3222Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3223@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3224[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3225
3226@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3227@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3228If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3229that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3230a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3231environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3232[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3233
3234@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3235@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3236Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3237[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3238
3239@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3240@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3241Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3242[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3243
3244@kindex --section-alignment
3245@item --section-alignment
3246Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3247addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3248[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3249
3250@cindex stack size
3251@kindex --stack
3252@item --stack @var{reserve}
3253@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3254Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3255to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3256committed.
3257[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3258
3259@kindex --subsystem
3260@item --subsystem @var{which}
3261@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3262@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3263Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3264legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3265@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3266the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3267@var{which}.
3268[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3269
3270The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3271of the PE file header:
3272[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3273
3274@kindex --high-entropy-va
3275@item --high-entropy-va
3276@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3277Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3278(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3279
3280This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3281@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3282
3283@kindex --dynamicbase
3284@item --dynamicbase
3285@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3286The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3287randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3288Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3289can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3290This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3291
3292@kindex --forceinteg
3293@item --forceinteg
3294@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3295Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3296default.
3297
3298@kindex --nxcompat
3299@item --nxcompat
3300@item --disable-nxcompat
3301The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3302This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3303targets. The option is enabled by default.
3304
3305@kindex --no-isolation
3306@item --no-isolation
3307@itemx --disable-no-isolation
3308Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3309This option is disabled by default.
3310
3311@kindex --no-seh
3312@item --no-seh
3313@itemx --disable-no-seh
3314The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3315this image. This option is disabled by default.
3316
3317@kindex --no-bind
3318@item --no-bind
3319@itemx --disable-no-bind
3320Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3321
3322@kindex --wdmdriver
3323@item --wdmdriver
3324@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3325The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3326by default.
3327
3328@kindex --tsaware
3329@item --tsaware
3330@itemx --disable-tsaware
3331The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3332default.
3333
3334@kindex --insert-timestamp
3335@item --insert-timestamp
3336@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3337Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3338as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3339other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3340will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3341same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3342can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3343that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3344identically.
3345
3346@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3347@item --enable-reloc-section
3348@itemx --disable-reloc-section
3349Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3350is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3351This option is enabled by default.
3352@end table
3353
3354@c man end
3355
3356@ifset C6X
3357@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3358
3359@c man begin OPTIONS
3360
3361The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3362libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3363all executables use an index of 0.
3364
3365@table @gcctabopt
3366
3367@kindex --dsbt-size
3368@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3369This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3370or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3371entries.
3372
3373@kindex --dsbt-index
3374@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3375This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3376to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3377executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3378@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3379
3380@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3381The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3382exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3383
3384@end table
3385
3386@c man end
3387@end ifset
3388
3389@ifset CSKY
3390@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3391
3392@c man begin OPTIONS
3393
3394@table @gcctabopt
3395
3396@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3397@item --branch-stub
3398This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3399sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3400usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3401can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3402the compiler or assembler.
3403
3404@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3405@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3406This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3407It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3408be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3409stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3410sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3411@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3412linker should choose suitable defaults.
3413
3414@end table
3415
3416@c man end
3417@end ifset
3418
3419@ifset M68HC11
3420@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3421
3422@c man begin OPTIONS
3423
3424The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3425memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3426
3427@table @gcctabopt
3428
3429@kindex --no-trampoline
3430@item --no-trampoline
3431This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3432is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3433instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3434
3435@kindex --bank-window
3436@item --bank-window @var{name}
3437This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3438the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3439The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3440paging and addresses within the memory window.
3441
3442@end table
3443
3444@c man end
3445@end ifset
3446
3447@ifset M68K
3448@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3449
3450@c man begin OPTIONS
3451
3452The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3453when linking for 68K targets.
3454
3455@table @gcctabopt
3456
3457@kindex --got
3458@item --got=@var{type}
3459This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3460@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3461@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3462Info entry for @file{ld}.
3463
3464@end table
3465
3466@c man end
3467@end ifset
3468
3469@ifset MIPS
3470@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3471
3472@c man begin OPTIONS
3473
3474The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3475generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3476linking for MIPS targets.
3477
3478@table @gcctabopt
3479
3480@kindex --insn32
3481@item --insn32
3482@kindex --no-insn32
3483@itemx --no-insn32
3484These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3485generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3486or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
348732-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3488used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3489possible.
3490
3491@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3492@item --ignore-branch-isa
3493@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3494@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3495These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3496transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3497accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3498is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3499instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3500equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3501calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3502a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3503an error.
3504
3505@kindex --compact-branches
3506@item --compact-branches
3507@kindex --no-compact-branches
3508@itemx --no-compact-branches
3509These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3510in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3511
3512@end table
3513
3514@c man end
3515@end ifset
3516
3517
3518@ifset PDP11
3519@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3520
3521@c man begin OPTIONS
3522
3523For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3524produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3525for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3526targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3527defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3528here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3529
3530@table @gcctabopt
3531
3532@kindex -N
3533@item -N
3534@kindex --omagic
3535@itemx --omagic
3536
3537Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3538indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3539shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3540writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3541the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3542programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3543from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3544
3545@kindex -n
3546@item -n
3547@kindex --nmagic
3548@itemx --nmagic
3549
3550Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3551indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3552be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3553file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3554byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3555a @emph{pure executable} format.
3556
3557@kindex -z
3558@item -z
3559@kindex --imagic
3560@itemx --imagic
3561
3562Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3563indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3564data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3565instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3566larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3567to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3568shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3569option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3570and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3571this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3572executable} format.
3573
3574@kindex --no-omagic
3575@item --no-omagic
3576
3577Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3578
3579@end table
3580
3581@c man end
3582@end ifset
3583
3584@ifset UsesEnvVars
3585@node Environment
3586@section Environment Variables
3587
3588@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3589
3590You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3591@ifclear SingleFormat
3592@code{GNUTARGET},
3593@end ifclear
3594@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3595
3596@ifclear SingleFormat
3597@kindex GNUTARGET
3598@cindex default input format
3599@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3600use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3601of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3602@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3603of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3604attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3605this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3606there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3607object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3608BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3609in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3610@end ifclear
3611
3612@kindex LDEMULATION
3613@cindex default emulation
3614@cindex emulation, default
3615@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3616@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3617behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3618available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3619the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3620variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3621linker was configured.
3622
3623@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3624@cindex demangling, default
3625Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3626@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3627default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3628a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3629may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3630options.
3631
3632@c man end
3633@end ifset
3634
3635@node Scripts
3636@chapter Linker Scripts
3637
3638@cindex scripts
3639@cindex linker scripts
3640@cindex command files
3641Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3642written in the linker command language.
3643
3644The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3645the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3646the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3647more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3648direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3649described below.
3650
3651The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3652yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3653linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3654to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3655such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3656
3657You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3658line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3659default linker script.
3660
3661You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3662to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3663Linker Scripts}.
3664
3665@menu
3666* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3667* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3668* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3669* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3670* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3671* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3672* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3673* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3674* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3675* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3676* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3677@end menu
3678
3679@node Basic Script Concepts
3680@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3681@cindex linker script concepts
3682We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3683describe the linker script language.
3684
3685The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3686file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3687@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3688The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3689purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3690among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3691section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3692in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3693
3694Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3695also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3696contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3697the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3698A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3699area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3700loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3701which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3702of debugging information.
3703
3704Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3705first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3706the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3707@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3708section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3709same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3710is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3711(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3712based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3713RAM address would be the VMA.
3714
3715You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3716program with the @samp{-h} option.
3717
3718Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3719@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3720has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3721information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3722will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3723static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3724referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3725
3726You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3727program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3728option.
3729
3730@node Script Format
3731@section Linker Script Format
3732@cindex linker script format
3733Linker scripts are text files.
3734
3735You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3736either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3737symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3738generally ignored.
3739
3740Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3741If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3742otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3743double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3744file name.
3745
3746You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3747@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3748to whitespace.
3749
3750@node Simple Example
3751@section Simple Linker Script Example
3752@cindex linker script example
3753@cindex example of linker script
3754Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3755
3756The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3757@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3758memory layout of the output file.
3759
3760The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3761describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3762code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3763@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3764Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3765your input files.
3766
3767For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
37680x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3769linker script which will do that:
3770@smallexample
3771SECTIONS
3772@{
3773 . = 0x10000;
3774 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3775 . = 0x8000000;
3776 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3777 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3778@}
3779@end smallexample
3780
3781You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3782followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3783descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3784
3785The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3786sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3787counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3788other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3789current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3790incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3791@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3792
3793The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3794required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3795after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3796which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3797wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3798means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3799
3800Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3801@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3802@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3803
3804The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3805the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3806at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3807output section, the value of the location counter will be
3808@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3809effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3810immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3811
3812The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3813alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3814example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3815sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3816may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3817sections.
3818
3819That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3820
3821@node Simple Commands
3822@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3823@cindex linker script simple commands
3824In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3825
3826@menu
3827* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3828* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3829@ifclear SingleFormat
3830* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3831@end ifclear
3832
3833* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3834* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3835@end menu
3836
3837@node Entry Point
3838@subsection Setting the Entry Point
3839@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3840@cindex start of execution
3841@cindex first instruction
3842@cindex entry point
3843The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3844point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3845entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3846@smallexample
3847ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3848@end smallexample
3849
3850There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3851entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3852stopping when one of them succeeds:
3853@itemize @bullet
3854@item
3855the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3856@item
3857the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3858@item
3859the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3860targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3861check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3862@item
3863the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
3864@item
3865The address @code{0}.
3866@end itemize
3867
3868@node File Commands
3869@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3870@cindex linker script file commands
3871Several linker script commands deal with files.
3872
3873@table @code
3874@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3875@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3876@cindex including a linker script
3877Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3878be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
3879with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
388010 levels deep.
3881
3882You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3883@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3884
3885@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3886@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3887@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3888@cindex input files in linker scripts
3889@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3890@cindex linker script input object files
3891The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3892in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3893
3894For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3895a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3896then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3897
3898In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3899script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3900
3901In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3902with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3903located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
3904for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3905@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3906filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3907@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3908
3909If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3910the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3911found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3912not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3913path.
3914
3915If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
3916name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
3917@samp{-l}.
3918
3919When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3920files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3921script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3922
3923@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3924@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3925@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3926@cindex grouping input files
3927The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3928files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3929new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
3930in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3931
3932@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3933@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3934@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3935This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3936commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3937as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3938with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3939when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3940@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3941and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3942setting afterwards.
3943
3944@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3945@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3946@cindex output file name in linker script
3947The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3948@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3949@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
3950Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
3951precedence.
3952
3953You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3954output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3955
3956@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3957@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3958@cindex library search path in linker script
3959@cindex archive search path in linker script
3960@cindex search path in linker script
3961The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
3962@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
3963@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
3964on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
3965are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
3966the command-line option are searched first.
3967
3968@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3969@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3970@cindex first input file
3971The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3972that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3973though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3974when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3975first file.
3976@end table
3977
3978@ifclear SingleFormat
3979@node Format Commands
3980@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
3981A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3982
3983@table @code
3984@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3985@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3986@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3987@cindex output file format in linker script
3988The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3989output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
3990exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
3991(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
3992line option takes precedence.
3993
3994You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
3995formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
3996This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3997desired endianness.
3998
3999If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4000will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4001output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4002used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4003
4004For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4005command:
4006@smallexample
4007OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4008@end smallexample
4009This says that the default format for the output file is
4010@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4011option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4012format.
4013
4014@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4015@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4016@cindex input file format in linker script
4017The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4018files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4019This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4020(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4021is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4022command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4023@end table
4024@end ifclear
4025
4026@node REGION_ALIAS
4027@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4028@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4029@cindex region alias
4030@cindex region names
4031
4032Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4033@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4034
4035@smallexample
4036REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4037@end smallexample
4038
4039The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4040memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4041to memory regions. An example follows.
4042
4043Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4044memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4045that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4046non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4047access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4048read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4049sections:
4050
4051@itemize @bullet
4052@item
4053@code{.text} program code;
4054@item
4055@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4056@item
4057@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4058@item
4059@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4060@end itemize
4061
4062The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4063part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4064output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4065systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4066@code{C}:
4067@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4068@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4069@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4070@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4071@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4072@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4073@end multitable
4074The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4075loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4076the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4077the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4078
4079The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4080includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4081memory layout:
4082@smallexample
4083INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4084
4085SECTIONS
4086 @{
4087 .text :
4088 @{
4089 *(.text)
4090 @} > REGION_TEXT
4091 .rodata :
4092 @{
4093 *(.rodata)
4094 rodata_end = .;
4095 @} > REGION_RODATA
4096 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4097 @{
4098 data_start = .;
4099 *(.data)
4100 @} > REGION_DATA
4101 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4102 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4103 .bss :
4104 @{
4105 *(.bss)
4106 @} > REGION_BSS
4107 @}
4108@end smallexample
4109
4110Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4111regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4112variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4113@table @code
4114@item A
4115Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4116@smallexample
4117MEMORY
4118 @{
4119 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4120 @}
4121
4122REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4123REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4124REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4125REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4126@end smallexample
4127@item B
4128Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4129into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4130@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4131@smallexample
4132MEMORY
4133 @{
4134 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4135 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4136 @}
4137
4138REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4139REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4140REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4141REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4142@end smallexample
4143@item C
4144Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4145@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4146initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4147system start into the @code{RAM}.
4148@smallexample
4149MEMORY
4150 @{
4151 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4152 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4153 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4154 @}
4155
4156REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4157REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4158REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4159REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4160@end smallexample
4161@end table
4162
4163It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4164@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4165necessary:
4166@smallexample
4167#include <string.h>
4168
4169extern char data_start [];
4170extern char data_size [];
4171extern char data_load_start [];
4172
4173void copy_data(void)
4174@{
4175 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4176 @{
4177 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4178 @}
4179@}
4180@end smallexample
4181
4182@node Miscellaneous Commands
4183@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4184There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4185
4186@table @code
4187@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4188@kindex ASSERT
4189@cindex assertion in linker script
4190Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4191with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4192
4193Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4194take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4195inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4196for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4197symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4198
4199@smallexample
4200 .stack :
4201 @{
4202 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4203 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4204 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4205 @}
4206@end smallexample
4207
4208will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4209PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4210can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4211
4212@smallexample
4213 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4214 .stack :
4215 @{
4216 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4217 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4218 @}
4219@end smallexample
4220
4221will work.
4222
4223@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4224@kindex EXTERN
4225@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4226Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4227symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4228modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4229each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4230command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4231
4232@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4233@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4234@cindex common allocation in linker script
4235This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4236to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4237output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4238
4239@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4240@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4241@cindex common allocation in linker script
4242This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4243command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4244to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4245
4246@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4247@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4248@cindex group allocation in linker script
4249@cindex section groups
4250@cindex COMDAT
4251This command has the same effect as the
4252@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4253@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4254and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4255specified (@samp{-r}).
4256
4257@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4258@kindex INSERT
4259@cindex insert user script into default script
4260This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4261augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4262inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4263@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4264default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4265sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4266linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4267insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4268linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4269default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4270of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4271to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4272is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4273
4274@smallexample
4275SECTIONS
4276@{
4277 OVERLAY :
4278 @{
4279 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4280 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4281 @}
4282@}
4283INSERT AFTER .text;
4284@end smallexample
4285
4286@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4287@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4288@cindex cross references
4289This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4290references among certain output sections.
4291
4292In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4293using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4294will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4295errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4296a function defined in the other section.
4297
4298The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4299@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4300an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4301@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4302names.
4303
4304@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4305@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4306@cindex cross references
4307This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4308references to one section from a list of other sections.
4309
4310The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4311output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4312a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4313there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4314must never call back.
4315
4316The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4317The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4318If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4319the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4320status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4321names, not input section names.
4322
4323@ifclear SingleFormat
4324@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4325@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4326@cindex machine architecture
4327@cindex architecture
4328Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4329of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4330architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4331the @samp{-f} option.
4332@end ifclear
4333
4334@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4335@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4336This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4337@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4338in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4339@xref{Expression Section}.
4340@end table
4341
4342@node Assignments
4343@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4344@cindex assignment in scripts
4345@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4346@cindex variables, defining
4347You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4348the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4349
4350@menu
4351* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4352* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4353* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4354* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4355* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4356@end menu
4357
4358@node Simple Assignments
4359@subsection Simple Assignments
4360
4361You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4362
4363@table @code
4364@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4365@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4366@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4367@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4368@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4369@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4370@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4371@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4372@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4373@end table
4374
4375The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4376@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4377defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4378
4379The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4380may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4381
4382The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4383
4384Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4385
4386You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4387statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4388section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4389
4390The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4391expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4392
4393Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4394assignments may be used:
4395
4396@smallexample
4397floating_point = 0;
4398SECTIONS
4399@{
4400 .text :
4401 @{
4402 *(.text)
4403 _etext = .;
4404 @}
4405 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4406 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4407@}
4408@end smallexample
4409@noindent
4410In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4411zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4412the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4413defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4414upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4415
4416@node HIDDEN
4417@subsection HIDDEN
4418@cindex HIDDEN
4419For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4420exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4421
4422Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4423@code{HIDDEN}:
4424
4425@smallexample
4426HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4427SECTIONS
4428@{
4429 .text :
4430 @{
4431 *(.text)
4432 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4433 @}
4434 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4435 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4436@}
4437@end smallexample
4438@noindent
4439In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4440
4441@node PROVIDE
4442@subsection PROVIDE
4443@cindex PROVIDE
4444In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4445only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4446the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4447@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4448@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4449@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4450@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4451@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4452
4453Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4454@smallexample
4455SECTIONS
4456@{
4457 .text :
4458 @{
4459 *(.text)
4460 _etext = .;
4461 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4462 @}
4463@}
4464@end smallexample
4465
4466In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4467underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4468on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4469underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4470If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4471linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4472
4473Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4474defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4475that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4476when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4477@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4478
4479@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4480@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4481@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4482Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4483hidden and won't be exported.
4484
4485@node Source Code Reference
4486@subsection Source Code Reference
4487
4488Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4489intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4490a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4491symbol that does not have a value.
4492
4493Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4494transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4495stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4496prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4497mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4498of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4499variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4500linker script variable might be referred to as:
4501
4502@smallexample
4503 extern int foo;
4504@end smallexample
4505
4506But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4507
4508@smallexample
4509 _foo = 1000;
4510@end smallexample
4511
4512In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4513transformation has taken place.
4514
4515When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4516things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4517in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4518second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4519table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4520contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4521value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4522
4523@smallexample
4524 int foo = 1000;
4525@end smallexample
4526
4527creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4528holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4529number 1000 is initially stored.
4530
4531When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4532first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4533memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4534So:
4535
4536@smallexample
4537 foo = 1;
4538@end smallexample
4539
4540looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4541associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4542address. Whereas:
4543
4544@smallexample
4545 int * a = & foo;
4546@end smallexample
4547
4548looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4549and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4550the variable @samp{a}.
4551
4552Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4553the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4554an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4555
4556@smallexample
4557 foo = 1000;
4558@end smallexample
4559
4560creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4561the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4562address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4563linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4564access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4565
4566Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4567you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4568use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4569section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4570linker script contains these declarations:
4571
4572@smallexample
4573@group
4574 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4575 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4576 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4577@end group
4578@end smallexample
4579
4580Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4581
4582@smallexample
4583@group
4584 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4585
4586 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4587@end group
4588@end smallexample
4589
4590Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4591Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4592arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4593
4594@smallexample
4595@group
4596 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4597
4598 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4599@end group
4600@end smallexample
4601
4602Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4603operators.
4604
4605@node SECTIONS
4606@section SECTIONS Command
4607@kindex SECTIONS
4608The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4609into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4610
4611The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4612@smallexample
4613SECTIONS
4614@{
4615 @var{sections-command}
4616 @var{sections-command}
4617 @dots{}
4618@}
4619@end smallexample
4620
4621Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4622
4623@itemize @bullet
4624@item
4625an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4626@item
4627a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4628@item
4629an output section description
4630@item
4631an overlay description
4632@end itemize
4633
4634The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4635@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4636those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4637understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4638the layout of the output file.
4639
4640Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4641below.
4642
4643If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4644linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4645section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4646input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4647example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4648in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4649
4650@menu
4651* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4652* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4653* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4654* Input Section:: Input section description
4655* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4656* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4657* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4658* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4659* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4660@end menu
4661
4662@node Output Section Description
4663@subsection Output Section Description
4664The full description of an output section looks like this:
4665@smallexample
4666@group
4667@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4668 [AT(@var{lma})]
4669 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4670 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4671 [@var{constraint}]
4672 @{
4673 @var{output-section-command}
4674 @var{output-section-command}
4675 @dots{}
4676 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4677@end group
4678@end smallexample
4679
4680Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4681
4682The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4683name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4684The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4685the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4686The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4687
4688Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4689
4690@itemize @bullet
4691@item
4692a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4693@item
4694an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4695@item
4696data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4697@item
4698a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4699@end itemize
4700
4701@node Output Section Name
4702@subsection Output Section Name
4703@cindex name, section
4704@cindex section name
4705The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4706meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4707support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4708must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4709example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4710output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4711names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4712quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4713characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4714commas must be quoted.
4715
4716The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4717Discarding}.
4718
4719@node Output Section Address
4720@subsection Output Section Address
4721@cindex address, section
4722@cindex section address
4723The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4724address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4725is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4726
4727If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4728section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4729to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4730alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4731contained within the output section.
4732
4733The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4734
4735@itemize @bullet
4736@item
4737If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4738is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4739in that region.
4740
4741@item
4742If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4743regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4744section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4745be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4746
4747@item
4748If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4749the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4750counter.
4751@end itemize
4752
4753@noindent
4754For example:
4755
4756@smallexample
4757.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4758@end smallexample
4759
4760@noindent
4761and
4762
4763@smallexample
4764.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4765@end smallexample
4766
4767@noindent
4768are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4769@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4770counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4771counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4772input sections.
4773
4774The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4775For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4776so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4777do something like this:
4778@smallexample
4779.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4780@end smallexample
4781@noindent
4782This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4783aligned upward to the specified value.
4784
4785Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4786location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4787sections are ignored).
4788
4789@node Input Section
4790@subsection Input Section Description
4791@cindex input sections
4792@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4793The most common output section command is an input section description.
4794
4795The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4796You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4797in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4798map the input files into your memory layout.
4799
4800@menu
4801* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4802* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4803* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4804* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4805* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4806@end menu
4807
4808@node Input Section Basics
4809@subsubsection Input Section Basics
4810@cindex input section basics
4811An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4812by a list of section names in parentheses.
4813
4814The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4815describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4816
4817The most common input section description is to include all input
4818sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4819include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4820@smallexample
4821*(.text)
4822@end smallexample
4823@noindent
4824Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4825@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4826of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4827match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4828example:
4829@smallexample
4830EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4831@end smallexample
4832@noindent
4833will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4834and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4835placed inside the section list, for example:
4836@smallexample
4837*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4838@end smallexample
4839@noindent
4840The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4841two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4842more than one section, as described below.
4843
4844There are two ways to include more than one section:
4845@smallexample
4846*(.text .rdata)
4847*(.text) *(.rdata)
4848@end smallexample
4849@noindent
4850The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4851@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4852first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4853they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4854@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4855@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4856
4857When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4858is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4859immediately following section, for example:
4860@smallexample
4861*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4862@end smallexample
4863@noindent
4864will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4865@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4866from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4867exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4868could be modified to:
4869@smallexample
4870*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4871@end smallexample
4872@noindent
4873Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4874before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4875all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4876@smallexample
4877EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4878@end smallexample
4879
4880You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4881You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4882needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4883@smallexample
4884data.o(.data)
4885@end smallexample
4886
4887To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4888of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4889
4890Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4891
4892@smallexample
4893@group
4894SECTIONS @{
4895 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4896 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4897@}
4898@end group
4899@end smallexample
4900
4901In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4902input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4903@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4904@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4905whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4906
4907You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4908matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4909with no whitespace around the colon.
4910
4911@table @samp
4912@item archive:file
4913matches file within archive
4914@item archive:
4915matches the whole archive
4916@item :file
4917matches file but not one in an archive
4918@end table
4919
4920Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4921wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4922single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4923@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4924within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4925also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4926other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4927from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4928command.
4929
4930If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4931the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4932commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4933@smallexample
4934data.o
4935@end smallexample
4936
4937When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4938and does not contain any wild card
4939characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4940name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4941did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4942though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4943@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4944the archive search path.
4945
4946@node Input Section Wildcards
4947@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
4948@cindex input section wildcards
4949@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4950@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4951@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4952In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4953name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4954
4955The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4956pattern for the file name.
4957
4958The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4959
4960@table @samp
4961@item *
4962matches any number of characters
4963@item ?
4964matches any single character
4965@item [@var{chars}]
4966matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4967character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4968@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4969@item \
4970quotes the following character
4971@end table
4972
4973When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4974will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4975Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4976exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4977@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4978a @samp{/} character.
4979
4980File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4981specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4982does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4983
4984If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4985appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4986will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4987sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4988@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4989@smallexample
4990.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4991.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4992@end smallexample
4993
4994@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
4995Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4996in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
4997this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4998pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4999@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5000into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5001
5002@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5003@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5004@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5005alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5006alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5007needed.
5008
5009@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5010@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5011@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5012numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5013section name before placing them in the output file. In
5014@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5015the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5016@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5017
5018@cindex SORT
5019@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5020
5021When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5022can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5023
5024@enumerate
5025@item
5026@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5027It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5028sections have the same name.
5029@item
5030@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5031It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5032sections have the same alignment.
5033@item
5034@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5035treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5036@item
5037@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5038is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5039@item
5040All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5041@end enumerate
5042
5043When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5044section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5045takes precedence over the command-line option.
5046
5047If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5048command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5049treated as nested sorting command.
5050
5051@enumerate
5052@item
5053@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5054@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5055@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5056@item
5057@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5058@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5059@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5060@end enumerate
5061
5062If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5063command-line option will be ignored.
5064
5065@cindex SORT_NONE
5066@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5067section sorting option.
5068
5069If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5070@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5071precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5072
5073This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5074files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5075sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5076The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5077with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5078linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5079@smallexample
5080@group
5081SECTIONS @{
5082 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5083 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5084 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5085 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5086@}
5087@end group
5088@end smallexample
5089
5090@node Input Section Common
5091@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5092@cindex common symbol placement
5093@cindex uninitialized data placement
5094A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5095file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5096linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5097named @samp{COMMON}.
5098
5099You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5100other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5101particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5102input files are placed in another section.
5103
5104In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5105@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5106@smallexample
5107.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5108@end smallexample
5109
5110@cindex scommon section
5111@cindex small common symbols
5112Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5113example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5114symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5115different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5116the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5117symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5118to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5119locations.
5120
5121@cindex [COMMON]
5122You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5123notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5124@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5125
5126@node Input Section Keep
5127@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5128@cindex KEEP
5129@cindex garbage collection
5130When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5131it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5132This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5133with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5134@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5135
5136@node Input Section Example
5137@subsubsection Input Section Example
5138The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5139to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5140start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5141@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5142follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5143@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5144@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5145All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5146files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5147
5148@smallexample
5149@group
5150SECTIONS @{
5151 outputa 0x10000 :
5152 @{
5153 all.o
5154 foo.o (.input1)
5155 @}
5156@end group
5157@group
5158 outputb :
5159 @{
5160 foo.o (.input2)
5161 foo1.o (.input1)
5162 @}
5163@end group
5164@group
5165 outputc :
5166 @{
5167 *(.input1)
5168 *(.input2)
5169 @}
5170@}
5171@end group
5172@end smallexample
5173
5174If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5175and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5176automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5177__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5178indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5179respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5180C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5181
5182@node Output Section Data
5183@subsection Output Section Data
5184@cindex data
5185@cindex section data
5186@cindex output section data
5187@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5188@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5189@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5190@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5191@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5192You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5193@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5194an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5195parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5196value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5197counter.
5198
5199The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5200store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5201bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5202stored.
5203
5204For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5205of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5206@smallexample
5207BYTE(1)
5208LONG(addr)
5209@end smallexample
5210
5211When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5212same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5213target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5214@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5215@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5216
5217If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5218which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5219When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5220true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5221endianness of the first input object file.
5222
5223Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5224between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5225@smallexample
5226SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5227@end smallexample
5228whereas this will work:
5229@smallexample
5230SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5231@end smallexample
5232
5233@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5234@cindex holes, filling
5235@cindex unspecified memory
5236You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5237current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5238otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5239gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5240with the value of the expression, repeated as
5241necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5242point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5243than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5244different parts of an output section.
5245
5246This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5247value @samp{0x90}:
5248@smallexample
5249FILL(0x90909090)
5250@end smallexample
5251
5252The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5253section attribute, but it only affects the
5254part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5255entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5256precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5257expression.
5258
5259@node Output Section Keywords
5260@subsection Output Section Keywords
5261There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5262commands.
5263
5264@table @code
5265@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5266@cindex input filename symbols
5267@cindex filename symbols
5268@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5269The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5270The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5271file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5272the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5273
5274This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5275normally used for any other object file format.
5276
5277@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5278@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5279@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5280@item CONSTRUCTORS
5281When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5282unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5283destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5284arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5285automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5286For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5287linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5288@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5289ignored for other object file formats.
5290
5291The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5292constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5293Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5294the start and end of the global destructors. The
5295first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5296of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5297compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5298formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5299@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5300the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5301destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5302@code{exit}.
5303
5304For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5305arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5306addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5307and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5308linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5309runtime code expects to see.
5310
5311@smallexample
5312 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5313 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5314 *(.ctors)
5315 LONG(0)
5316 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5317 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5318 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5319 *(.dtors)
5320 LONG(0)
5321 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5322@end smallexample
5323
5324If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5325which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5326are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5327are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5328command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5329@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5330@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5331@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5332
5333Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5334and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5335need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5336scripts.
5337
5338@end table
5339
5340@node Output Section Discarding
5341@subsection Output Section Discarding
5342@cindex discarding sections
5343@cindex sections, discarding
5344@cindex removing sections
5345The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5346This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5347may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5348@smallexample
5349.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5350@end smallexample
5351@noindent
5352will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5353@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5354sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5355space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5356too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5357space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5358@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5359@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5360This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5361
5362The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5363on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5364symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5365the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5366section is discarded.
5367
5368@cindex /DISCARD/
5369The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5370input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5371section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5372
5373This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5374@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5375garbage collection.
5376
5377Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5378discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5379members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5380Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5381
5382@node Output Section Attributes
5383@subsection Output Section Attributes
5384@cindex output section attributes
5385We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5386like this:
5387
5388@smallexample
5389@group
5390@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5391 [AT(@var{lma})]
5392 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5393 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5394 [@var{constraint}]
5395 @{
5396 @var{output-section-command}
5397 @var{output-section-command}
5398 @dots{}
5399 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5400@end group
5401@end smallexample
5402
5403We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5404@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5405remaining section attributes.
5406
5407@menu
5408* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5409* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5410* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5411* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5412* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5413* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5414* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5415* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5416@end menu
5417
5418@node Output Section Type
5419@subsubsection Output Section Type
5420Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5421parentheses. The following types are defined:
5422
5423@table @code
5424@item NOLOAD
5425The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5426loaded into memory when the program is run.
5427@item DSECT
5428@itemx COPY
5429@itemx INFO
5430@itemx OVERLAY
5431These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5432rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5433marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5434section when the program is run.
5435@end table
5436
5437@kindex NOLOAD
5438@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5439@cindex loading, preventing
5440The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5441the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5442the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5443@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5444need to be loaded when the program is run.
5445@smallexample
5446@group
5447SECTIONS @{
5448 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5449 @dots{}
5450@}
5451@end group
5452@end smallexample
5453
5454@node Output Section LMA
5455@subsubsection Output Section LMA
5456@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5457@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5458@cindex load address
5459@cindex section load address
5460Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5461@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5462@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5463specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5464address is optional.
5465
5466The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5467specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5468takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5469load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5470region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5471
5472If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5473section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5474load address:
5475
5476@itemize @bullet
5477@item
5478If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5479the LMA address as well.
5480
5481@item
5482If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5483
5484@item
5485Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5486with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5487section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5488VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5489the last section in the located region.
5490
5491@item
5492If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5493that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5494
5495@item
5496If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5497section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5498@end itemize
5499
5500@cindex ROM initialized data
5501@cindex initialized data in ROM
5502This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5503example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5504called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5505@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5506even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5507uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5508defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5509counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5510
5511@smallexample
5512@group
5513SECTIONS
5514 @{
5515 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5516 .mdata 0x2000 :
5517 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5518 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5519 .bss 0x3000 :
5520 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5521@}
5522@end group
5523@end smallexample
5524
5525The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5526this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5527the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5528how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5529script.
5530
5531@smallexample
5532@group
5533extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5534char *src = &_etext;
5535char *dst = &_data;
5536
5537/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5538while (dst < &_edata)
5539 *dst++ = *src++;
5540
5541/* Zero bss. */
5542for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5543 *dst = 0;
5544@end group
5545@end smallexample
5546
5547@node Forced Output Alignment
5548@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5549@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5550@cindex forcing output section alignment
5551@cindex output section alignment
5552You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5553alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5554intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5555
5556@node Forced Input Alignment
5557@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5558@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5559@cindex forcing input section alignment
5560@cindex input section alignment
5561You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5562SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5563sections, whether larger or smaller.
5564
5565@node Output Section Constraint
5566@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5567@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5568@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5569@cindex constraints on output sections
5570You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5571of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5572read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5573@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5574
5575@node Output Section Region
5576@subsubsection Output Section Region
5577@kindex >@var{region}
5578@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5579@cindex memory regions and sections
5580You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5581using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5582
5583Here is a simple example:
5584@smallexample
5585@group
5586MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5587SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5588@end group
5589@end smallexample
5590
5591@node Output Section Phdr
5592@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5593@kindex :@var{phdr}
5594@cindex section, assigning to program header
5595@cindex program headers and sections
5596You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5597using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5598one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5599assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5600@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5601linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5602
5603Here is a simple example:
5604@smallexample
5605@group
5606PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5607SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5608@end group
5609@end smallexample
5610
5611@node Output Section Fill
5612@subsubsection Output Section Fill
5613@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5614@cindex section fill pattern
5615@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5616You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5617@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5618(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5619within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5620alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5621necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5622of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5623an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5624fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5625other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5626pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5627expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5628
5629You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5630output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5631
5632Here is a simple example:
5633@smallexample
5634@group
5635SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5636@end group
5637@end smallexample
5638
5639@node Overlay Description
5640@subsection Overlay Description
5641@kindex OVERLAY
5642@cindex overlays
5643An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5644are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5645the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5646copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5647required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5648can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5649than another.
5650
5651Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5652@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5653output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5654command is as follows:
5655@smallexample
5656@group
5657OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5658 @{
5659 @var{secname1}
5660 @{
5661 @var{output-section-command}
5662 @var{output-section-command}
5663 @dots{}
5664 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5665 @var{secname2}
5666 @{
5667 @var{output-section-command}
5668 @var{output-section-command}
5669 @dots{}
5670 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5671 @dots{}
5672 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5673@end group
5674@end smallexample
5675
5676Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5677section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5678section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5679those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5680except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5681sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5682
5683The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5684the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5685
5686The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5687addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5688memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5689whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5690and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5691and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5692
5693If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5694references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5695the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5696sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5697@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5698
5699For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5700provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5701defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5702@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5703the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5704within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5705symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5706
5707At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5708the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5709
5710Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5711@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5712@smallexample
5713@group
5714 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5715 @{
5716 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5717 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5718 @}
5719@end group
5720@end smallexample
5721@noindent
5722This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5723address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5724@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5725following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5726@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5727@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5728
5729C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5730like the following.
5731
5732@smallexample
5733@group
5734 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5735 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5736 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5737@end group
5738@end smallexample
5739
5740Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5741everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5742example could have been written identically as follows.
5743
5744@smallexample
5745@group
5746 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5747 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5748 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5749 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5750 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5751 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5752 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5753@end group
5754@end smallexample
5755
5756@node MEMORY
5757@section MEMORY Command
5758@kindex MEMORY
5759@cindex memory regions
5760@cindex regions of memory
5761@cindex allocating memory
5762@cindex discontinuous memory
5763The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5764memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5765
5766The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5767memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5768may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5769can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5770set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5771regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5772around to fit into the available regions.
5773
5774A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5775however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5776specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5777@code{MEMORY} is:
5778@smallexample
5779@group
5780MEMORY
5781 @{
5782 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5783 @dots{}
5784 @}
5785@end group
5786@end smallexample
5787
5788The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5789region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5790Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5791with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5792must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5793add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5794command.
5795
5796@cindex memory region attributes
5797The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5798whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5799not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5800@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5801section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5802the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5803them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5804
5805The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5806@table @samp
5807@item R
5808Read-only section
5809@item W
5810Read/write section
5811@item X
5812Executable section
5813@item A
5814Allocatable section
5815@item I
5816Initialized section
5817@item L
5818Same as @samp{I}
5819@item !
5820Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5821@end table
5822
5823If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5824@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5825attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5826unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5827not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5828string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5829or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5830the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5831
5832@kindex ORIGIN =
5833@kindex o =
5834@kindex org =
5835The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5836the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5837cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5838abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5839@code{ORG}).
5840
5841@kindex LENGTH =
5842@kindex len =
5843@kindex l =
5844The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5845region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5846be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5847@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5848
5849In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5850available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5851and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5852linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5853is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5854or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5855explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5856region.
5857
5858@smallexample
5859@group
5860MEMORY
5861 @{
5862 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5863 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5864 @}
5865@end group
5866@end smallexample
5867
5868Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5869specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5870@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5871a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5872output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5873was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5874the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5875output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5876region, the linker will issue an error message.
5877
5878It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
5879expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
5880@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5881
5882@smallexample
5883@group
5884 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
5885@end group
5886@end smallexample
5887
5888@node PHDRS
5889@section PHDRS Command
5890@kindex PHDRS
5891@cindex program headers
5892@cindex ELF program headers
5893@cindex program segments
5894@cindex segments, ELF
5895The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5896@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5897loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5898program with the @samp{-p} option.
5899
5900When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5901reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5902program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5903This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5904interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5905
5906The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5907in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5908precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5909the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5910not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5911
5912The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5913generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5914ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5915
5916This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5917@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5918
5919@smallexample
5920@group
5921PHDRS
5922@{
5923 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5924 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5925@}
5926@end group
5927@end smallexample
5928
5929The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5930of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5931header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5932with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5933must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5934is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
5935
5936Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5937system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5938specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5939sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5940attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5941Section Phdr}.
5942
5943It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5944merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5945repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5946contain the section.
5947
5948If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5949then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5950not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5951convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5952placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5953default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5954segment at all.
5955
5956@kindex FILEHDR
5957@kindex PHDRS
5958You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
5959the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5960The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5961file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5962include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
5963segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5964these keywords.
5965
5966The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5967value of the keyword.
5968
5969@table @asis
5970@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5971Indicates an unused program header.
5972
5973@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5974Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5975the file.
5976
5977@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5978Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5979
5980@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5981Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5982found.
5983
5984@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5985Indicates a segment holding note information.
5986
5987@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5988A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5989ABI.
5990
5991@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5992Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5993
5994@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5995Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5996
5997@item @var{expression}
5998An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5999be used for types not defined above.
6000@end table
6001
6002You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6003in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6004@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6005Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6006output section attribute.
6007
6008The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6009which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6010explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6011an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6012header.
6013
6014Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6015headers used on a native ELF system.
6016
6017@example
6018@group
6019PHDRS
6020@{
6021 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6022 interp PT_INTERP ;
6023 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6024 data PT_LOAD ;
6025 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6026@}
6027
6028SECTIONS
6029@{
6030 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6031 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6032 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6033 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6034 @dots{}
6035 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6036 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6037 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6038 @dots{}
6039@}
6040@end group
6041@end example
6042
6043@node VERSION
6044@section VERSION Command
6045@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6046@cindex symbol versions
6047@cindex version script
6048@cindex versions of symbols
6049The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6050only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6051symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6052a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6053shared library.
6054
6055You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6056you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6057also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6058
6059The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6060@smallexample
6061VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6062@end smallexample
6063
6064The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6065Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6066version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6067version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6068version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6069scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6070library.
6071
6072The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6073examples.
6074
6075@smallexample
6076VERS_1.1 @{
6077 global:
6078 foo1;
6079 local:
6080 old*;
6081 original*;
6082 new*;
6083@};
6084
6085VERS_1.2 @{
6086 foo2;
6087@} VERS_1.1;
6088
6089VERS_2.0 @{
6090 bar1; bar2;
6091 extern "C++" @{
6092 ns::*;
6093 "f(int, double)";
6094 @};
6095@} VERS_1.2;
6096@end smallexample
6097
6098This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6099version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6100The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6101a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6102of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6103symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6104is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6105in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6106However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6107name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6108
6109Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6110depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6111to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6112
6113Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6114depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6115and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6116
6117When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6118specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6119unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6120unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6121somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6122wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6123wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6124set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6125ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6126
6127The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6128they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6129could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6130However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6131
6132Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6133in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6134symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6135won't.
6136
6137@smallexample
6138@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6139@end smallexample
6140
6141When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6142symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6143requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6144shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6145loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6146linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6147application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6148way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6149all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6150search for each symbol reference.
6151
6152The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6153doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6154that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6155functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6156the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6157required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6158that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6159versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6160the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6161
6162There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6163first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6164source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6165script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6166maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6167@smallexample
6168__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6169@end smallexample
6170@noindent
6171in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6172be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6173The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6174@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6175takes precedence over a version script.
6176
6177The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6178function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6179an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6180version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6181linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6182
6183To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6184source file. Here is an example:
6185
6186@smallexample
6187__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6188__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6189__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6190__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6191@end smallexample
6192
6193In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6194unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6195example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6196@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6197
6198When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6199some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6200this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6201@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6202declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6203you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6204
6205If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6206within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6207(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6208specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6209
6210You can also specify the language in the version script:
6211
6212@smallexample
6213VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6214@end smallexample
6215
6216The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6217The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6218demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6219patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6220@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6221
6222Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6223described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6224or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6225the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6226whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6227cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6228might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6229should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6230expect when you upgrade.
6231
6232@node Expressions
6233@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6234@cindex expressions
6235@cindex arithmetic
6236The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6237that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6238expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6239host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6240
6241You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6242
6243The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6244expressions.
6245
6246@menu
6247* Constants:: Constants
6248* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6249* Symbols:: Symbol Names
6250* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6251* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6252* Operators:: Operators
6253* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6254* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6255* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6256@end menu
6257
6258@node Constants
6259@subsection Constants
6260@cindex integer notation
6261@cindex constants in linker scripts
6262All constants are integers.
6263
6264As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6265octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6266hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6267@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6268@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6269value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6270
6271@cindex scaled integers
6272@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6273@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6274@cindex suffixes for integers
6275@cindex integer suffixes
6276In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6277constant by
6278@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6279@ifnottex
6280@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6281@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6282@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6283@end ifnottex
6284@tex
6285${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6286@end tex
6287@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6288respectively. For example, the following
6289all refer to the same quantity:
6290
6291@smallexample
6292_fourk_1 = 4K;
6293_fourk_2 = 4096;
6294_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6295_fourk_4 = 10000o;
6296@end smallexample
6297
6298Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6299conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6300
6301@node Symbolic Constants
6302@subsection Symbolic Constants
6303@cindex symbolic constants
6304@kindex CONSTANT
6305It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6306the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6307
6308@table @code
6309@item MAXPAGESIZE
6310@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6311The target's maximum page size.
6312
6313@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6314@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6315The target's default page size.
6316@end table
6317
6318So for example:
6319
6320@smallexample
6321 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6322@end smallexample
6323
6324will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6325supported by the target.
6326
6327@node Symbols
6328@subsection Symbol Names
6329@cindex symbol names
6330@cindex names
6331@cindex quoted symbol names
6332@kindex "
6333Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6334and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6335Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6336specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6337keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6338@smallexample
6339"SECTION" = 9;
6340"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6341@end smallexample
6342
6343Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6344to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6345whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6346
6347@node Orphan Sections
6348@subsection Orphan Sections
6349@cindex orphan
6350Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6351are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6352script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6353output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6354in which to place the orphaned input section.
6355
6356If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6357an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6358placed at the end of that output section.
6359
6360If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6361sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6362name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6363orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6364one new output section.
6365
6366If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6367then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6368in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6369linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6370attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6371sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6372support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6373
6374The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6375(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6376output sections an orphan is placed in.
6377
6378@node Location Counter
6379@subsection The Location Counter
6380@kindex .
6381@cindex dot
6382@cindex location counter
6383@cindex current output location
6384The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6385current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6386location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6387within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6388anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6389
6390@cindex holes
6391Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6392moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6393location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6394and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6395doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6396
6397@smallexample
6398SECTIONS
6399@{
6400 output :
6401 @{
6402 file1(.text)
6403 . = . + 1000;
6404 file2(.text)
6405 . += 1000;
6406 file3(.text)
6407 @} = 0x12345678;
6408@}
6409@end smallexample
6410@noindent
6411In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6412located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6413followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6414@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6415@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6416specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6417
6418@cindex dot inside sections
6419Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6420current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6421statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6422absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6423however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6424not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6425
6426@smallexample
6427SECTIONS
6428@{
6429 . = 0x100
6430 .text: @{
6431 *(.text)
6432 . = 0x200
6433 @}
6434 . = 0x500
6435 .data: @{
6436 *(.data)
6437 . += 0x600
6438 @}
6439@}
6440@end smallexample
6441
6442The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6443and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6444the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6445much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6446move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6447and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6448the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6449the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6450
6451@cindex dot outside sections
6452Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6453output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6454needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6455
6456@smallexample
6457SECTIONS
6458@{
6459 start_of_text = . ;
6460 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6461 end_of_text = . ;
6462
6463 start_of_data = . ;
6464 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6465 end_of_data = . ;
6466@}
6467@end smallexample
6468
6469If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6470not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6471between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6472should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6473blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6474the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6475sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6476statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6477special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6478place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6479as follows:
6480
6481@smallexample
6482SECTIONS
6483@{
6484 start_of_text = . ;
6485 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6486 end_of_text = . ;
6487
6488 start_of_data = . ;
6489 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6490 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6491 end_of_data = . ;
6492@}
6493@end smallexample
6494
6495This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6496@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6497placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6498assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6499a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6500section. So you could write:
6501
6502@smallexample
6503SECTIONS
6504@{
6505 start_of_text = . ;
6506 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6507 end_of_text = . ;
6508
6509 . = . ;
6510 start_of_data = . ;
6511 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6512 end_of_data = . ;
6513@}
6514@end smallexample
6515
6516Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6517@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6518
6519@need 2000
6520@node Operators
6521@subsection Operators
6522@cindex operators for arithmetic
6523@cindex arithmetic operators
6524@cindex precedence in expressions
6525The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6526the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6527@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6528@ifnottex
6529@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6530@smallexample
6531precedence associativity Operators Notes
6532(highest)
65331 left ! - ~ (1)
65342 left * / %
65353 left + -
65364 left >> <<
65375 left == != > < <= >=
65386 left &
65397 left |
65408 left &&
65419 left ||
654210 right ? :
654311 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6544(lowest)
6545@end smallexample
6546Notes:
6547(1) Prefix operators
6548(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6549@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6550@end ifnottex
6551@tex
6552\vskip \baselineskip
6553%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6554\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6555\hrule
6556\halign
6557{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6558height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6559&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6560height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6561\noalign{\hrule}
6562height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6563&highest&&&&&\cr
6564% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6565&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6566&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6567&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6568&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6569&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6570&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6571&7&&left&&|&\cr
6572&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6573&9&&left&&||&\cr
6574&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6575&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6576&lowest&&&&&\cr
6577height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6578\hrule}
6579@end tex
6580@iftex
6581{
6582@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6583@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6584@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6585}
6586@end iftex
6587@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6588
6589@node Evaluation
6590@subsection Evaluation
6591@cindex lazy evaluation
6592@cindex expression evaluation order
6593The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6594an expression when absolutely necessary.
6595
6596The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6597address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6598regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6599as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6600
6601However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6602until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6603other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6604for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6605
6606The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6607assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6608allocation.
6609
6610Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6611@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6612
6613If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6614available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6615following
6616@smallexample
6617@group
6618SECTIONS
6619 @{
6620 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6621 @{ *(.text) @}
6622 @}
6623@end group
6624@end smallexample
6625@noindent
6626will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6627address}.
6628
6629@node Expression Section
6630@subsection The Section of an Expression
6631@cindex expression sections
6632@cindex absolute expressions
6633@cindex relative expressions
6634@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6635@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6636@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6637Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6638relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6639using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6640value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6641symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6642operations.
6643
6644Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6645section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6646address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6647@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6648functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6649One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6650(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6651differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6652versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6653section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6654Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6655absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6656given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6657everywhere.
6658
6659In the following simple example,
6660
6661@smallexample
6662@group
6663SECTIONS
6664 @{
6665 . = 0x100;
6666 __executable_start = 0x100;
6667 .data :
6668 @{
6669 . = 0x10;
6670 __data_start = 0x10;
6671 *(.data)
6672 @}
6673 @dots{}
6674 @}
6675@end group
6676@end smallexample
6677
6678both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6679address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6680@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6681section in the second two assignments.
6682
6683For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6684addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6685
6686@itemize @bullet
6687@item
6688Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6689operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6690absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6691@item
6692Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6693relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6694and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6695@item
6696Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6697in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6698address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6699before applying the operator.
6700@end itemize
6701
6702The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6703
6704@itemize @bullet
6705@item
6706An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6707@item
6708The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6709@item
6710The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6711relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6712(after above conversions) is also a number when
6713@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6714but an absolute address otherwise.
6715@item
6716The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6717relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6718section as the relative operand(s).
6719@item
6720The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6721conversions) is an absolute address.
6722@end itemize
6723
6724You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6725to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6726create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6727section @samp{.data}:
6728@smallexample
6729SECTIONS
6730 @{
6731 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6732 @}
6733@end smallexample
6734@noindent
6735If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6736@samp{.data} section.
6737
6738Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6739particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6740
6741@node Builtin Functions
6742@subsection Builtin Functions
6743@cindex functions in expressions
6744The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6745use in linker script expressions.
6746
6747@table @code
6748@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6749@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6750@cindex expression, absolute
6751Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6752of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6753value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6754normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6755
6756@item ADDR(@var{section})
6757@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6758@cindex section address in expression
6759Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6760script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6761the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6762@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6763@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6764the other two will be absolute:
6765@smallexample
6766@group
6767SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6768 .output1 :
6769 @{
6770 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6771 @dots{}
6772 @}
6773 .output :
6774 @{
6775 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6776 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6777 @}
6778@dots{} @}
6779@end group
6780@end smallexample
6781
6782@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6783@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6784@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6785@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6786@cindex round up location counter
6787@cindex align location counter
6788@cindex round up expression
6789@cindex align expression
6790Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6791to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6792doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6793arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6794expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6795equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6796
6797Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6798next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6799variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6800input sections:
6801@smallexample
6802@group
6803SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6804 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6805 *(.data)
6806 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6807 @}
6808@dots{} @}
6809@end group
6810@end smallexample
6811@noindent
6812The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6813a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6814a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6815of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6816
6817The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6818
6819@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6820@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6821@cindex section alignment
6822Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6823been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6824evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6825the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6826value in that section.
6827@smallexample
6828@group
6829SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6830 .output @{
6831 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6832 @dots{}
6833 @}
6834@dots{} @}
6835@end group
6836@end smallexample
6837
6838@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6839@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6840This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6841scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6842section.
6843
6844@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6845@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6846This is equivalent to either
6847@smallexample
6848(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6849@end smallexample
6850or
6851@smallexample
6852(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6853 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6854@end smallexample
6855@noindent
6856depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6857for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6858@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6859If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6860memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6861bytes in the on-disk file.
6862
6863This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6864any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6865@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6866be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6867running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6868that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6869page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
6870
6871@noindent
6872Example:
6873@smallexample
6874 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6875@end smallexample
6876
6877@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6878@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6879This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6880evaluation purposes.
6881
6882@smallexample
6883 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6884@end smallexample
6885
6886@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6887@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6888This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
6889@samp{-z relro} option is used.
6890When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6891does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
6892@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6893argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6894script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
6895@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6896padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6897section alignment.
6898
6899@smallexample
6900 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6901@end smallexample
6902
6903@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6904@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6905@cindex symbol defaults
6906Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
6907defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6908return 0. You can use this function to provide
6909default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6910shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6911the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6912existed, its value is preserved:
6913
6914@smallexample
6915@group
6916SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6917 .text : @{
6918 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6919 @dots{}
6920 @}
6921 @dots{}
6922@}
6923@end group
6924@end smallexample
6925
6926@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6927@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6928Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6929
6930@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6931@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6932@cindex section load address in expression
6933Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
6934Section LMA}).
6935
6936@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6937@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6938Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6939@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6940
6941@kindex MAX
6942@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6943Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6944
6945@kindex MIN
6946@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6947Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6948
6949@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6950@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6951@cindex unallocated address, next
6952Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6953This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6954use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6955output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6956
6957@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6958@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6959Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6960
6961@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6962@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6963Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
6964value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6965@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6966will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6967can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
6968``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
6969name.
6970
6971@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6972@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6973@cindex section size
6974Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6975been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6976evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6977@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6978@smallexample
6979@group
6980SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6981 .output @{
6982 .start = . ;
6983 @dots{}
6984 .end = . ;
6985 @}
6986 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6987 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6988@dots{} @}
6989@end group
6990@end smallexample
6991
6992@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6993@itemx sizeof_headers
6994@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6995@cindex header size
6996Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6997information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6998this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6999choose, to facilitate paging.
7000
7001@cindex not enough room for program headers
7002@cindex program headers, not enough room
7003When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7004@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7005number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7006addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7007additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7008room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7009the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7010script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7011you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7012command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7013@end table
7014
7015@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7016@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7017@cindex implicit linker scripts
7018If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7019an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7020linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7021linker will report an error.
7022
7023An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7024
7025Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7026assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7027commands.
7028
7029Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7030at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7031read. This can affect archive searching.
7032
7033@node Plugins
7034@chapter Linker Plugins
7035
7036@cindex plugins
7037@cindex linker plugins
7038The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7039For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7040support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7041
7042Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7043be added here later.
7044
7045@menu
7046* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7047@end menu
7048
7049@node libdep Plugin
7050@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7051@cindex static library dependencies
7052Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7053just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7054optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7055within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7056rose to ascendance.
7057
7058One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7059multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7060dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7061library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7062referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7063link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7064libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7065explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7066
7067The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7068to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7069plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7070dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7071and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7072command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7073utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7074being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7075archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7076
7077For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7078library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7079the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7080
7081@smallexample
7082-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7083@end smallexample
7084
7085@ifset GENERIC
7086@node Machine Dependent
7087@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7088
7089@cindex machine dependencies
7090@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7091sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7092functionality are not listed.
7093
7094@menu
7095@ifset H8300
7096* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7097@end ifset
7098@ifset M68HC11
7099* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7100@end ifset
7101@ifset ARM
7102* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7103@end ifset
7104@ifset HPPA
7105* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7106@end ifset
7107@ifset M68K
7108* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7109@end ifset
7110@ifset MIPS
7111* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7112@end ifset
7113@ifset MMIX
7114* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7115@end ifset
7116@ifset MSP430
7117* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7118@end ifset
7119@ifset NDS32
7120* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7121@end ifset
7122@ifset NIOSII
7123* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7124@end ifset
7125@ifset POWERPC
7126* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7127@end ifset
7128@ifset POWERPC64
7129* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7130@end ifset
7131@ifset S/390
7132* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7133@end ifset
7134@ifset SPU
7135* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7136@end ifset
7137@ifset TICOFF
7138* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7139@end ifset
7140@ifset WIN32
7141* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7142@end ifset
7143@ifset XTENSA
7144* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7145@end ifset
7146@end menu
7147@end ifset
7148
7149@ifset H8300
7150@ifclear GENERIC
7151@raisesections
7152@end ifclear
7153
7154@node H8/300
7155@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7156
7157@cindex H8/300 support
7158For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7159you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7160
7161@table @emph
7162@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7163@item relaxing address modes
7164@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7165targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7166program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7167respectively.
7168
7169@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7170@item synthesizing instructions
7171@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7172@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7173sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7174page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7175(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7176@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7177top page of memory).
7178
7179@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7180indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7181displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7182the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7183@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7184whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7185range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7186
7187@item bit manipulation instructions
7188@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7189biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7190which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7191page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7192(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7193@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7194the top page of memory).
7195
7196@item system control instructions
7197@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
719832 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7199changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7200(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7201@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7202the top page of memory).
7203@end table
7204
7205@ifclear GENERIC
7206@lowersections
7207@end ifclear
7208@end ifset
7209
7210@ifclear GENERIC
7211@ifset Renesas
7212@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7213@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7214@node Renesas
7215@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7216
7217@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7218H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7219options are required for these chips.
7220@end ifset
7221@end ifclear
7222
7223@ifset ARM
7224@ifclear GENERIC
7225@raisesections
7226@end ifclear
7227
7228@ifset M68HC11
7229@ifclear GENERIC
7230@raisesections
7231@end ifclear
7232
7233@node M68HC11/68HC12
7234@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7235
7236@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7237
7238@subsection Linker Relaxation
7239
7240For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7241optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7242
7243@table @emph
7244@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7245@item relaxing address modes
7246@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7247targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7248program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7249respectively.
7250
7251@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7252transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7253page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7254
7255@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7256When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7257of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7258addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7259@code{bset} instructions.
7260
7261@end table
7262
7263@subsection Trampoline Generation
7264
7265@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7266@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7267For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7268call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7269will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7270trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7271case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7272point to the function trampoline.
7273
7274@ifclear GENERIC
7275@lowersections
7276@end ifclear
7277@end ifset
7278
7279@node ARM
7280@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7281
7282@cindex ARM interworking support
7283@kindex --support-old-code
7284For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7285between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7286been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7287line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7288libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7289option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7290given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7291which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7292the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7293non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7294
7295@cindex thumb entry point
7296@cindex entry point, thumb
7297@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7298The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7299@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7300But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7301branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7302executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7303
7304@cindex PE import table prefixing
7305@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7306The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7307the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7308element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7309import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7310
7311@cindex BE8
7312@kindex --be8
7313The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7314executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7315objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7316option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7317little-endian code.
7318
7319@cindex TARGET1
7320@kindex --target1-rel
7321@kindex --target1-abs
7322The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7323@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7324or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7325and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7326
7327@cindex TARGET2
7328@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7329The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7330@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7331meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7332@table @samp
7333@item rel
7334@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7335@item abs
7336@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7337@item got-rel
7338@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7339@end table
7340
7341@cindex FIX_V4BX
7342@kindex --fix-v4bx
7343The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7344specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7345interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7346also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7347
7348In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7349linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7350@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7351
7352In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7353relocations are ignored.
7354
7355@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7356@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7357Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7358relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7359
7360@smallexample
7361TST rM, #1
7362MOVEQ PC, rM
7363BX Rn
7364@end smallexample
7365
7366This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7367and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7368condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7369
7370@cindex USE_BLX
7371@kindex --use-blx
7372The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7373BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7374situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7375code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7376each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7377
7378@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7379@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7380The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7381bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7382instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7383to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7384the support code can read the intended values.
7385
7386The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7387intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7388and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7389intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7390full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7391you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7392
7393If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7394enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7395@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7396mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7397vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7398@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7399
7400If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7401potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7402such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7403first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7404instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7405the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7406are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7407
7408@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7409@kindex --fix-arm1176
7410@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7411The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7412in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7413are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7414unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7415
7416Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7417Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7418http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7419
7420@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7421@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7422
7423The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7424workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7425the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7426off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7427the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7428core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7429integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7430VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7431
7432The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7433necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7434
7435The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7436@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7437STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7438linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7439@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7440
7441If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7442potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7443such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7444replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7445branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7446then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7447
7448The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7449the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7450
7451The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7452they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7453there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7454occurs.
7455
7456The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7457PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7458large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7459cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7460occurs.
7461
7462@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7463@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7464The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7465warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7466enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7467linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7468using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7469not be diagnosed.
7470
7471@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7472@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7473The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7474warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7475@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7476linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7477using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7478
7479@cindex PIC_VENEER
7480@kindex --pic-veneer
7481The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7482ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7483is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7484@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7485
7486@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7487@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7488The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7489code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7490perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7491placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7492controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7493The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7494duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7495group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7496code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7497where they should be placed.
7498
7499The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7500@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7501placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7502branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7503placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7504value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7505exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7506A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7507linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7508from the input sections.
7509
7510The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7511@samp{N = +1}.
7512
7513Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7514only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7515otherwise.
7516
7517@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7518@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7519@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7520The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7521
7522The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7523
7524@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7525@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7526@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7527The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7528
7529Please contact ARM for further details.
7530
7531@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7532@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7533@cindex Merging exidx entries
7534The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7535
7536@kindex --long-plt
7537@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7538The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7539which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7540entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7541
7542@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7543@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7544The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7545link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7546
7547@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7548All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7549Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7550@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7551veneers in memory.
7552
7553@kindex --cmse-implib
7554@cindex Secure gateway import library
7555The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7556specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7557secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7558executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7559
7560@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7561@cindex Input import library
7562The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7563must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7564given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7565in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7566@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7567library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7568library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7569for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7570specified.
7571
7572@ifclear GENERIC
7573@lowersections
7574@end ifclear
7575@end ifset
7576
7577@ifset HPPA
7578@ifclear GENERIC
7579@raisesections
7580@end ifclear
7581
7582@node HPPA ELF32
7583@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7584@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7585@kindex --multi-subspace
7586When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7587import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7588The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7589stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7590multiple sub-spaces.
7591
7592@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7593@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7594Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7595stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7596@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7597sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7598a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7599the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7600conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7601prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7602A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7603branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7604@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7605@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7606detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7607positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7608
7609Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7610single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7611create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7612large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7613
7614@ifclear GENERIC
7615@lowersections
7616@end ifclear
7617@end ifset
7618
7619@ifset M68K
7620@ifclear GENERIC
7621@raisesections
7622@end ifclear
7623
7624@node M68K
7625@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7626
7627@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7628@kindex --got=@var{type}
7629The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7630The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7631@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7632the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7633@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7634entries only at non-negative offsets.
7635@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7636entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7637support such GOTs.
7638@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7639output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7640file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7641files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7642
7643@ifclear GENERIC
7644@lowersections
7645@end ifclear
7646@end ifset
7647
7648@ifset MIPS
7649@ifclear GENERIC
7650@raisesections
7651@end ifclear
7652
7653@node MIPS
7654@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7655
7656@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7657@kindex --insn32
7658@kindex --no-insn32
7659The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7660microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7661in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7662used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7663or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7664including 16-bit ones where possible.
7665
7666@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7667@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7668@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7669The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7670control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7671@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7672relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7673calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7674relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7675instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7676or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7677the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7678
7679@ifclear GENERIC
7680@lowersections
7681@end ifclear
7682@end ifset
7683
7684@ifset MMIX
7685@ifclear GENERIC
7686@raisesections
7687@end ifclear
7688
7689@node MMIX
7690@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7691For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7692@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7693understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7694can translate between the two formats.
7695
7696There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7697Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7698registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7699equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7700@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7701global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7702this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7703symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7704
7705Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7706@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7707The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7708of a section.
7709
7710Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7711are left out from an mmo file.
7712
7713@ifclear GENERIC
7714@lowersections
7715@end ifclear
7716@end ifset
7717
7718@ifset MSP430
7719@ifclear GENERIC
7720@raisesections
7721@end ifclear
7722
7723@node MSP430
7724@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7725For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7726will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7727just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7728
7729@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7730The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7731
7732@table @code
7733@item @samp{.vectors}
7734Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7735
7736@item @samp{.bootloader}
7737Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7738in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7739
7740@item @samp{.infomem}
7741Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7742this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7743
7744@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7745This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7746in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7747
7748@item @samp{.noinit}
7749Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7750
7751The last two sections are used by gcc.
7752@end table
7753
7754@table @option
7755@cindex MSP430 Options
7756@kindex --code-region
7757@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7758This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7759argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7760using this option.
7761
7762@kindex --data-region
7763@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7764This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7765[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7766for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7767
7768@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7769@item --disable-sec-transformation
7770Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7771and @code{--data-region} options.
7772This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7773wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7774not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7775@end table
7776
7777@ifclear GENERIC
7778@lowersections
7779@end ifclear
7780@end ifset
7781
7782@ifset NDS32
7783@ifclear GENERIC
7784@raisesections
7785@end ifclear
7786
7787@node NDS32
7788@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7789@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7790For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7791relaxes objects according to these options.
7792
7793@table @code
7794@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7795Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7796
7797@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7798Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7799
7800@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7801Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7802
7803@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7804Export the EX9 table after linking.
7805
7806@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7807Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7808
7809@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7810Update the existing EX9 table.
7811
7812@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7813Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7814
7815@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7816Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7817
7818@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7819Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7820
7821@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7822Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7823@end table
7824
7825@ifclear GENERIC
7826@lowersections
7827@end ifclear
7828@end ifset
7829
7830@ifset NIOSII
7831@ifclear GENERIC
7832@raisesections
7833@end ifclear
7834
7835@node Nios II
7836@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7837@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7838@kindex --relax on Nios II
7839
7840Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7841transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7842which may result in @command{ld} giving
7843@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7844The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7845trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7846outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7847trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7848be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7849larger than 256MB.
7850
7851The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7852is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7853@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7854locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7855source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7856register as a temporary.
7857
7858Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7859relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7860option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7861
7862@ifclear GENERIC
7863@lowersections
7864@end ifclear
7865@end ifset
7866
7867@ifset POWERPC
7868@ifclear GENERIC
7869@raisesections
7870@end ifclear
7871
7872@node PowerPC ELF32
7873@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7874@cindex PowerPC long branches
7875@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7876Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7877displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7878@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7879@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7880the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7881section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
7882section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7883@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7884both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7885considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
7886
7887@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7888@table @option
7889@cindex PowerPC PLT
7890@kindex --bss-plt
7891@item --bss-plt
7892Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7893generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7894the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7895writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7896@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7897PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7898compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7899BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7900
7901@kindex --secure-plt
7902@item --secure-plt
7903@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7904@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7905when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7906layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7907style BSS PLT.
7908
7909@cindex PowerPC GOT
7910@kindex --sdata-got
7911@item --sdata-got
7912The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7913sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7914@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7915section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7916@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7917@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7918@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7919@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7920PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7921pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7922GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7923really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7924
7925@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7926@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7927@item --emit-stub-syms
7928This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7929symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7930
7931@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7932@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7933@item --no-tls-optimize
7934PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7935sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7936disable the optimization.
7937@end table
7938
7939@ifclear GENERIC
7940@lowersections
7941@end ifclear
7942@end ifset
7943
7944@ifset POWERPC64
7945@ifclear GENERIC
7946@raisesections
7947@end ifclear
7948
7949@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7950@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7951
7952@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7953@table @option
7954@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7955@kindex --stub-group-size
7956@item --stub-group-size
7957Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7958by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7959@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7960sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7961a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7962the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7963conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7964prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7965A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7966branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7967@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7968@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7969detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7970positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7971
7972Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7973single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7974create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7975large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7976
7977@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7978@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7979@item --emit-stub-syms
7980This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7981symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7982
7983@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7984@kindex --dotsyms
7985@kindex --no-dotsyms
7986@item --dotsyms
7987@itemx --no-dotsyms
7988These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7989in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7990function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7991code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7992properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7993to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7994@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7995dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7996feature.
7997
7998@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7999@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8000@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8001@item --save-restore-funcs
8002@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8003These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8004provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8005@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8006function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8007link.
8008
8009@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8010@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8011@item --no-tls-optimize
8012PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8013sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8014disable the optimization.
8015
8016@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8017@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8018@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8019@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8020@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8021@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8022@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8023These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8024stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8025an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8026@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8027stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8028generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8029__tls_get_addr_opt.
8030Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8031much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8032an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8033will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8034@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8035and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8036this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8037Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8038@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8039register saves.
8040
8041@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8042@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8043@item --no-opd-optimize
8044PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8045corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8046the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8047Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8048
8049@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8050@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8051@item --non-overlapping-opd
8052Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8053@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8054the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8055entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8056
8057@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8058@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8059@item --no-toc-optimize
8060PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8061entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8062reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8063marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8064marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8065relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8066unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8067reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8068discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8069reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8070code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8071optimization.
8072
8073@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8074@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8075@item --no-inline-optimize
8076PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8077marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8078@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8079a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8080locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8081disables that optimization.
8082
8083@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8084@kindex --no-multi-toc
8085@item --no-multi-toc
8086If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8087@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8088where TOC
8089entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8090total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8091grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8092TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8093calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8094help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
809564K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8096Use this option to turn off this feature.
8097
8098@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8099@kindex --no-toc-sort
8100@item --no-toc-sort
8101By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8102happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8103placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8104with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8105referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8106@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8107results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8108off this feature.
8109
8110@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8111@kindex --plt-align
8112@kindex --no-plt-align
8113@item --plt-align
8114@itemx --no-plt-align
8115Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8116aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8117boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8118specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8119specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8120if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8121PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8122
8123@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8124@kindex --plt-static-chain
8125@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8126@item --plt-static-chain
8127@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8128Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8129chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8130chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8131
8132@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8133@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8134@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8135@item --plt-thread-safe
8136@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8137With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8138lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8139another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8140order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8141memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8142barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8143looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8144seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8145default behaviour.
8146
8147@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8148@kindex --plt-localentry
8149@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8150@item --plt-localentry
8151@itemx --no-localentry
8152ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8153ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8154(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8155Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8156or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8157functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8158in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8159interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8160including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8161to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8162complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8163care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8164
8165@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8166@kindex --power10-stubs
8167@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8168@item --power10-stubs
8169@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8170When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8171relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8172linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8173for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8174power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8175power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8176allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8177@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8178auto mode.
8179@end table
8180
8181@ifclear GENERIC
8182@lowersections
8183@end ifclear
8184@end ifset
8185
8186@ifset S/390
8187@ifclear GENERIC
8188@raisesections
8189@end ifclear
8190
8191@node S/390 ELF
8192@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8193
8194@cindex S/390 ELF options
8195@table @option
8196
8197@cindex S/390
8198@kindex --s390-pgste
8199@item --s390-pgste
8200This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8201segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8202binaries marked that way.
8203@end table
8204
8205@ifclear GENERIC
8206@lowersections
8207@end ifclear
8208@end ifset
8209
8210@ifset SPU
8211@ifclear GENERIC
8212@raisesections
8213@end ifclear
8214
8215@node SPU ELF
8216@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8217
8218@cindex SPU ELF options
8219@table @option
8220
8221@cindex SPU plugins
8222@kindex --plugin
8223@item --plugin
8224This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8225
8226@cindex SPU overlays
8227@kindex --no-overlays
8228@item --no-overlays
8229Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8230regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8231@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8232turns off all this special overlay handling.
8233
8234@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8235@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8236@item --emit-stub-syms
8237This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8238symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8239
8240@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8241@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8242@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8243This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8244function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8245on calls to non-overlay regions.
8246
8247@cindex SPU local store size
8248@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8249@item --local-store=lo:hi
8250@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8251the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8252range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8253
8254@cindex SPU
8255@kindex --stack-analysis
8256@item --stack-analysis
8257SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8258unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8259under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8260@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8261@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8262determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8263for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8264for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8265for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8266find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8267and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8268under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8269dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8270is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8271and calls will be given.
8272
8273@cindex SPU
8274@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8275@item --emit-stack-syms
8276This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8277in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8278These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8279functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8280functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8281such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8282The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8283@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8284@end table
8285
8286@ifclear GENERIC
8287@lowersections
8288@end ifclear
8289@end ifset
8290
8291@ifset TICOFF
8292@ifclear GENERIC
8293@raisesections
8294@end ifclear
8295
8296@node TI COFF
8297@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8298@cindex TI COFF versions
8299@kindex --format=@var{version}
8300The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8301TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8302also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8303format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8304header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8305
8306@ifclear GENERIC
8307@lowersections
8308@end ifclear
8309@end ifset
8310
8311@ifset WIN32
8312@ifclear GENERIC
8313@raisesections
8314@end ifclear
8315
8316@node WIN32
8317@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8318
8319This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8320See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8321command-line options mentioned here.
8322
8323@table @emph
8324@cindex import libraries
8325@item import libraries
8326The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8327libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8328regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8329archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8330support for creating such libraries provided with the
8331@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8332
8333@item exporting DLL symbols
8334@cindex exporting DLL symbols
8335The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8336
8337@table @emph
8338@item using auto-export functionality
8339@cindex using auto-export functionality
8340By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8341which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8342
8343@itemize
8344@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8345@item --exclude-symbols
8346@item --exclude-libs
8347@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8348@item --version-script
8349@end itemize
8350
8351When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8352(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8353symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8354often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8355private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8356options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8357exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8358final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8359
8360If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8361command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8362if either of the following are true:
8363
8364@itemize
8365@item A DEF file is used.
8366@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8367@end itemize
8368
8369@item using a DEF file
8370@cindex using a DEF file
8371Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8372an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8373exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8374name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8375command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8376
8377@example
8378gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8379@end example
8380
8381Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8382@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8383
8384Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8385
8386@example
8387LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8388
8389EXPORTS
8390foo
8391bar
8392_bar = bar
8393another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8394var1 DATA
8395doo = foo == foo2
8396eoo DATA == var1
8397@end example
8398
8399This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8400symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8401alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8402by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8403@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8404@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8405export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8406in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8407symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8408
8409The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8410name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8411the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8412
8413When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8414library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8415@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8416executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8417
8418With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8419specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8420non-default base address for the image.
8421
8422If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8423or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8424filename specified on the command line.
8425
8426The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8427
8428@example
8429EXPORTS
8430 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8431 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8432 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8433@end example
8434
8435Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8436@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8437@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8438@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8439Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8440@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8441string in import/export table for the symbol.
8442
8443The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8444
8445@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8446will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8447by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8448linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8449library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8450
8451@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8452The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8453the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8454@code{*_imp__foo}).
8455
8456@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8457well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8458read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8459variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8460the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8461extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8462application will behave unexpectedly.
8463
8464@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8465it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8466symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8467API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8468the DLL without an import library.
8469
8470See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8471other DEF file statements
8472
8473@cindex creating a DEF file
8474While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8475with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8476
8477@item Using decorations
8478@cindex Using decorations
8479Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8480itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8481declared as:
8482
8483@example
8484__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8485__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8486@end example
8487
8488All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8489any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8490this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8491the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8492
8493Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8494decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8495instead:
8496
8497@example
8498__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8499__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8500@end example
8501
8502This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8503when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8504variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8505code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8506of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8507omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8508@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8509information.
8510@end table
8511
8512@cindex automatic data imports
8513@item automatic data imports
8514The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8515by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8516compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8517issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8518code to these platforms, especially for large
8519c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8520initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8521decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8522platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8523command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8524The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8525suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8526trigger the feature's use.
8527
8528auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8529additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8530
8531"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8532documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8533
8534The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8535occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8536One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8537below.
8538
8539@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8540For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8541object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8542offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8543field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8544in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8545without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8546The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8547references.
8548
8549The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8550be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8551themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8552runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8553compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8554support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8555run without error on an older system.
8556
8557@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8558enabled as needed.
8559
8560@cindex direct linking to a dll
8561@item direct linking to a dll
8562The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8563including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8564libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8565traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8566libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8567function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8568though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8569storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8570tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8571large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8572
8573Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8574@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8575of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8576perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8577select the dll instead of an import library.
8578
8579
8580For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8581to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8582
8583@example
8584libxxx.dll.a
8585xxx.dll.a
8586libxxx.a
8587xxx.lib
8588libxxx.lib
8589cygxxx.dll (*)
8590libxxx.dll
8591xxx.dll
8592@end example
8593
8594before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8595
8596(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8597where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8598@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8599file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8600@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8601
8602Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8603@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8604was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8605various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8606could coexist on the same machine.
8607
8608The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8609applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8610libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8611
8612@example
8613bin/
8614 cygxxx.dll
8615lib/
8616 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8617 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8618@end example
8619
8620Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8621done two ways:
8622
86231. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8624@example
8625gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8626@end example
8627
8628However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8629(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8630@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8631not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8632
86332. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8634directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8635should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8636making the app/dll.
8637
8638@example
8639ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8640@end example
8641
8642Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8643
8644@example
8645gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8646@end example
8647
8648This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8649perfectly legal
8650
8651@example
8652bin/
8653 cygxxx-5.dll
8654lib/
8655 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8656@end example
8657
8658Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8659even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8660@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8661
8662Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8663wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8664
86651. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8666work with auto-imported data.
8667
86682. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8669import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8670symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8671for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8672possible to do this without an import lib.
8673
86743. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8675critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8676in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8677stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8678
8679So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8680true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8681a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8682binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8683massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8684requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8685will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8686
8687@item symbol aliasing
8688@table @emph
8689@item adding additional names
8690Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8691A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8692exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8693when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8694import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8695
8696@example
8697LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8698
8699EXPORTS
8700foo
8701_foo = foo
8702@end example
8703
8704The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8705
8706Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8707source code using the "weak" attribute:
8708
8709@example
8710void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8711void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8712@end example
8713
8714See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8715symbols.
8716
8717@item renaming symbols
8718Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8719kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8720@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8721DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8722created). In the following example:
8723
8724@example
8725LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8726
8727EXPORTS
8728_foo = foo
8729@end example
8730
8731The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8732@samp{_foo}.
8733@end table
8734
8735Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8736unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8737If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8738@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8739that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8740@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8741renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8742to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8743the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8744In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8745which is probably not what you wanted.
8746
8747@cindex weak externals
8748@item weak externals
8749The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8750weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8751defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8752are three variants of weak externals:
8753@itemize
8754@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8755called lazy externals.
8756@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8757This form is not presently implemented.
8758@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8759implemented.
8760@end itemize
8761As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8762are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8763uses a default value.
8764
8765@cindex aligned common symbols
8766@item aligned common symbols
8767As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8768desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8769the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8770carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8771by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8772tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8773but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8774warnings about unknown linker directives.
8775
8776@end table
8777
8778@ifclear GENERIC
8779@lowersections
8780@end ifclear
8781@end ifset
8782
8783@ifset XTENSA
8784@ifclear GENERIC
8785@raisesections
8786@end ifclear
8787
8788@node Xtensa
8789@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8790
8791@cindex Xtensa processors
8792The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8793@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8794specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8795keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8796example, with the command:
8797
8798@smallexample
8799SECTIONS
8800@{
8801 .text : @{
8802 *(.literal .text)
8803 @}
8804@}
8805@end smallexample
8806
8807@noindent
8808@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8809and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8810literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8811interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8812group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8813files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8814and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8815
8816@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8817@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8818Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8819provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8820is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8821literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8822will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8823location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8824the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8825unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8826@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8827range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8828
8829For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8830to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8831instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8832instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8833instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8834@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8835hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8836By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8837switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8838density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8839instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8840performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8841linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8842a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8843
8844The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8845control the linker:
8846
8847@cindex Xtensa options
8848@table @option
8849@item --size-opt
8850When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8851more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8852no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8853alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8854preserve the correctness of the code.
8855
8856@item --abi-windowed
8857@itemx --abi-call0
8858Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8859PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8860because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8861conventions.
8862Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8863of the first input object.
8864A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8865or the chosen output object ABI.
8866@end table
8867
8868@ifclear GENERIC
8869@lowersections
8870@end ifclear
8871@end ifset
8872
8873@ifclear SingleFormat
8874@node BFD
8875@chapter BFD
8876
8877@cindex back end
8878@cindex object file management
8879@cindex object formats available
8880@kindex objdump -i
8881The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8882These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8883object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8884format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8885it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8886associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8887object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8888(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8889list all the formats available for your configuration.
8890
8891@cindex BFD requirements
8892@cindex requirements for BFD
8893As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8894several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8895BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8896formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8897been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8898BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8899may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8900
8901One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8902mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8903useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8904conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8905
8906@menu
8907* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8908@end menu
8909
8910@node BFD outline
8911@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
8912@cindex opening object files
8913@include bfdsumm.texi
8914@end ifclear
8915
8916@node Reporting Bugs
8917@chapter Reporting Bugs
8918@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8919@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
8920
8921Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
8922
8923Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8924it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
8925to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
8926work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
8927@command{ld}.
8928
8929In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8930information that enables us to fix the bug.
8931
8932@menu
8933* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8934* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8935@end menu
8936
8937@node Bug Criteria
8938@section Have You Found a Bug?
8939@cindex bug criteria
8940
8941If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8942
8943@itemize @bullet
8944@cindex fatal signal
8945@cindex linker crash
8946@cindex crash of linker
8947@item
8948If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
8949@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
8950
8951@cindex error on valid input
8952@item
8953If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
8954
8955@cindex invalid input
8956@item
8957If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
8958may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8959object files are correct.
8960
8961@item
8962If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
8963improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
8964@end itemize
8965
8966@node Bug Reporting
8967@section How to Report Bugs
8968@cindex bug reports
8969@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
8970
8971A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
8972products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
8973recommend you contact that organization first.
8974
8975You can find contact information for many support companies and
8976individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8977distribution.
8978
8979@ifset BUGURL
8980Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
8981@value{BUGURL}.
8982@end ifset
8983
8984The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8985@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8986fact or leave it out, state it!
8987
8988Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8989problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
8990assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8991matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8992the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8993location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8994were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8995into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8996specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
8997and the most helpful.
8998
8999Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9000the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9001on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9002
9003Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9004bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9005respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9006You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9007
9008To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9009
9010@itemize @bullet
9011@item
9012The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9013the @samp{--version} argument.
9014
9015Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9016the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9017
9018@item
9019Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9020patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9021
9022@item
9023The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9024version number.
9025
9026@item
9027What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9028``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9029
9030@item
9031The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9032observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9033list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9034sufficient.
9035
9036If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9037and then we might not encounter the bug.
9038
9039@item
9040A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9041bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9042provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9043bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9044state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9045requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9046we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9047attachments are best.
9048
9049If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9050@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9051object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9052@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9053how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9054
9055@item
9056A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9057incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9058
9059Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9060will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9061not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9062a chance to make a mistake.
9063
9064Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9065say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9066copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9067C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9068and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9069fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9070you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9071any conclusion from our observations.
9072
9073@item
9074If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9075diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9076@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9077If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9078context, not by line number.
9079
9080The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9081sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9082@end itemize
9083
9084Here are some things that are not necessary:
9085
9086@itemize @bullet
9087@item
9088A description of the envelope of the bug.
9089
9090Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9091which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9092changes will not affect it.
9093
9094This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9095will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9096with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9097We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9098
9099Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9100of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9101output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9102less time, and so on.
9103
9104However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9105report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9106
9107@item
9108A patch for the bug.
9109
9110A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9111the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9112a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9113to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9114
9115Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9116construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9117through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9118able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9119fixed.
9120
9121And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9122patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9123help us to understand.
9124
9125@item
9126A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9127
9128Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9129things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9130@end itemize
9131
9132@node MRI
9133@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9134@cindex MRI compatibility
9135To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9136linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9137alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9138described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9139simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9140@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9141linker commands; these commands are described here.
9142
9143In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9144file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9145features to make use of them.
9146
9147You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9148@samp{-c} command-line option.
9149
9150Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9151command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9152blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9153MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9154issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9155
9156Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9157
9158You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9159lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9160The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9161
9162@table @code
9163@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9164@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9165@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9166Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9167the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9168@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9169your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9170script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9171commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9172input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9173@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9174
9175@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9176@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9177Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9178in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9179
9180@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9181
9182@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9183@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9184Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9185@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9186
9187@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9188@item BASE @var{expression}
9189Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9190absolute addresses) in the output file.
9191
9192@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9193@item CHIP @var{expression}
9194@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9195This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9196
9197@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9198@item END
9199This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9200
9201@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9202@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9203Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9204language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9205
9206@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9207@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9208Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9209@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9210
9211The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9212same line, with no change in its effect.
9213
9214@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9215@item LOAD @var{filename}
9216@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9217Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9218same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9219command line.
9220
9221@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9222@item NAME @var{output-name}
9223@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9224MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9225option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9226
9227@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9228@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9229@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9230Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9231order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9232script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9233sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9234file, in the order specified.
9235
9236@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9237@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9238@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9239@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9240Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9241@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9242
9243@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9244@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9245@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9246@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9247You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9248specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9249If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9250@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9251@end table
9252
9253@node GNU Free Documentation License
9254@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9255@include fdl.texi
9256
9257@node LD Index
9258@unnumbered LD Index
9259
9260@printindex cp
9261
9262@tex
9263% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9264% meantime:
9265\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9266\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9267\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9268\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9269\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9270\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9271\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9272\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9273\page\colophon
9274% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9275@end tex
9276
9277@bye
This page took 0.047901 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.